HDD/DVD RECORDER
DVR-LX60D
®
®
Discover the benefits of registering your product online at
http://www.pioneer.co.uk (or http://www.pioneer.eu)
Operating Instructions
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating Environment
CAUTION
Operating environment temperature and humidity:
+5 ºC to +35 ºC (+41 ºF to +95 ºF); less than 85 %RH
(cooling vents not blocked)
The STANDBY/ON switch on this unit will not
completely shut off all power from the AC outlet.
Since the power cord serves as the main disconnect
device for the unit, you will need to unplug it from
the AC outlet to shut down all power. Therefore,
make sure the unit has been installed so that the
power cord can be easily unplugged from the AC
outlet in case of an accident. To avoid fire hazard,
the power cord should also be unplugged from the
AC outlet when left unused for a long period of time
Do not install this unit in a poorly ventilated area, or in
locations exposed to high humidity or direct sunlight (or
strong artificial light)
D3-4-2-1-7c_A_En
VENTILATION CAUTION
When installing this unit, make sure to leave space
around the unit for ventilation to improve heat
radiation (at least 10 cm at top, 10 cm at rear, and
10 cm at each side).
(for example, when on vacation).
D3-4-2-2-2a_A_En
WARNING
Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for
ventilation to ensure reliable operation of the
product, and to protect it from overheating. To
prevent fire hazard, the openings should never be
blocked or covered with items (such as newspapers,
table-cloths, curtains) or by operating the
This product is for general household purposes. Any
failure due to use for other than household purposes
(such as long-term use for business purposes in a
restaurant or use in a car or ship) and which
requires repair will be charged for even during the
warranty period.
K041_En
equipment on thick carpet or a bed.
D3-4-2-1-7b_A_En
POWER-CORD CAUTION
If the AC plug of this unit does not match the AC
outlet you want to use, the plug must be removed
and appropriate one fitted. Replacement and
mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of
this unit should be performed only by qualified
service personnel. If connected to an AC outlet, the
cut-off plug can cause severe electrical shock. Make
sure it is properly disposed of after removal.
Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not pull out the
plug by tugging the cord and never touch the power
cord when your hands are wet as this could cause a
short circuit or electric shock. Do not place the unit, a
piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or pinch the
cord. Never make a knot in the cord or tie it with other
cords. The power cords should be routed such that they
are not likely to be stepped on. A damaged power cord
can cause a fire or give you an electrical shock. Check
the power cord once in a while. When you find it
The equipment should be disconnected by removing
the mains plug from the wall socket when left
unused for a long period of time (for example, when
damaged, ask your nearest PIONEER authorized
service center or your dealer for a replacement. S002_En
on vacation).
D3-4-2-2-1a_A_En
Replacement and mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of this unit should be performed only by qualified
service personnel.
IMPORTANT: THE MOULDED PLUG
This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin mains plug for your safety and convenience. A 5 amp fuse is fitted in this plug. Should the
fuse need to be replaced, please ensure that the replacement fuse has a rating of 5 amps and that it is approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362.
Check for the ASTA mark
or the BSI mark
on the body of the fuse.
If the plug contains a removable fuse cover, you must ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is replaced. If you lose the fuse cover the plug
must not be used until a replacement cover is obtained. A replacement fuse cover can be obtained from your local dealer.
If the fitted moulded plug is unsuitable for your socket outlet, then the fuse shall be removed and the plug cut off and disposed of
safely. There is a danger of severe electrical shock if the cut off plug is inserted into any 13 amp socket.
If a new plug is to be fitted, please observe the wiring code as shown below. If in any doubt, please consult a qualified electrician.
IMPORTANT: The wires in this mains lead are coloured in accordance with the following code:
Blue : Neutral Brown : Live
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this appliance may not correspond with the coloured markings identifying the terminals in
your plug, proceed as follows ;
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the
letter N or coloured BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the
letter L or coloured RED.
How to replace the fuse: Open the fuse compartment with a screwdriver and replace the fuse.
D3-4-2-1-2-2_B_En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
05 Using the GUIDE Plus+®
Contents
01 Before you start
What’s in the box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Putting the batteries in the remote
control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Using the remote control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Disc/content format playback
electronic programme guide
The GUIDE Plus+® system . . . . . . . . . . 37
Using the GUIDE Plus+® system . . . . . 37
Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
GUIDE Plus+® FAQ and
troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
06 Using the digital electronic
programme guide
The Digital EPG system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Using the Digital EPG. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Setting timer programmes . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Other useful EPG functions . . . . . . . . . . 57
compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
About the internal hard disk drive . . . . . . 12
Symbols used in this manual . . . . . . . . . 13
02 Connections
Rear panel connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Front panel connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Connecting a TV antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Easy connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Using other types of audio/
video output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Connecting to a cable box or satellite
receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Connecting an external
07 Recording
About DVD recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
About HDD recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Recorded audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Restrictions on video recording . . . . . . . 61
Using the built-in A.TV and
D.TV tuners. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Setting the picture quality/
recording time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Basic recording from the TV . . . . . . . . . . 64
Pause Live TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
About timer recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Timer recording FAQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Simultaneous recording and playback
(Chase Play) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Recording from an external
component. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Playing your recordings on other DVD
players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Initializing recordable DVD discs . . . . . . 72
DVD-RW Auto Initialize. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
decoder box (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Connecting an external
decoder box (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Connecting to an AV amplifier/
receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Connecting using HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Connecting other AV sources . . . . . . . . . 22
Connecting a USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Plugging in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
03 Controls and displays
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Common Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
08 Playback
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Basic playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Using the Disc Navigator to browse the
contents of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Scanning discs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Playing in slow motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . 80
The Play Mode menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Displaying and switching subtitles . . . . . 82
04 Getting started
Switching on and setting up . . . . . . . . . . 30
For users receiving digital broadcast
services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®
system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
4
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Switching DVD and DivX
14 The Disc Setup menu
soundtracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Switching audio channels . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Switching camera angles . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Displaying disc information
Basic settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Initialize settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Finalize settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Optimize HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Initialize HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
on-screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
09 Playing and recording from a DV
camcorder
Playing from a DV camcorder . . . . . . . . . 85
Recording from a DV camcorder. . . . . . . 85
About DV. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
15 The Video Adjust menu
Setting the picture quality for TV and
external inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Setting the picture quality for disc
playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
10 Editing
Editing options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
The Disc Navigator screen. . . . . . . . . . . . 89
16 The Initial Setup menu
Using the Initial Setup menu . . . . . . . . 127
Selecting other languages for
language options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Using Software Update
(Digital tuner) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
11 Copying and backup
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
One Touch Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Using Copy Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Using disc backup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
17 Additional information
Setting up the remote to control
your TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Minimum copying times. . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Manual recording modes . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
If the picture freezes and the front panel
and remote control buttons stop
12 Using the Jukebox
Copying music to the HDD . . . . . . . . . . 108
Copying files via USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Playing music from the Jukebox . . . . . . 111
Editing Jukebox albums . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
working . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
On-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Front-panel displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Country/Area code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . 155
Handling discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Cleaning the pickup lens . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Hints on installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Moving the recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Resetting the recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
13 The PhotoViewer
Locating JPEG picture files . . . . . . . . . . 113
Changing the display style of the
PhotoViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Playing a slideshow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Reloading files from a disc or
USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Importing files to the HDD. . . . . . . . . . . 115
Selecting multiple files or folders . . . . . 116
Copying files to a DVD-R/-RW . . . . . . . . 116
Copying selected files to a
DVD-R/-RW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Editing files on the HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Printing files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
5
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
CBhaepfteor 1re you start
• Remove batteries from equipment that
isn’t going to be used for a month or
more.
What’s in the box
Please confirm that the following
accessories are in the box when you open it;
• When disposing of used batteries,
please comply with governmental
regulations or environmental public
instruction’s rules that apply in your
country or area.
• Remote control
• AA/R6P dry cell batteries x 2
• Audio/video cable (red/white/yellow)
• G-LINK™ cable
WARNING
• RF antenna cable x 2
• Power cable
Do not use or store batteries in direct sunlight or
other excessively hot place, such as inside a car or
near a heater. This can cause batteries to leak,
overheat, explode or catch fire. It can also reduce the
• These operating instructions
• Warranty card
life or performance of batteries.
D3-4-2-3-3_En
Using the remote control
Putting the batteries in the
remote control
Please keep in mind the following when
using the remote control:
• Make sure that there are no obstacles
between the remote and the remote
sensor on the unit.
•
Insert two AA/R6P batteries into the
battery compartment following the
indications (ꢀ,ꢁ) inside the
compartment.
• Remote operation may become
unreliable if strong sunlight or
fluorescent light is shining on the unit’s
remote sensor.
• Remote controllers for different devices
can interfere with each other. Avoid
using remotes for other equipment
located close to this unit.
• Replace the batteries when you notice a
fall off in the operating range of the
remote.
Important
Incorrect use of batteries can result in
hazards such as leakage and bursting.
Please observe the following:
• When the batteries run down or you
change the batteries, the remote control
mode is reset to Recorder 1. See Remote
Control Mode on page 139.
• Don’t mix new and old batteries
together.
• Use within the operating range in front of
the remote control sensor on the front
panel, as shown.
• Don’t use different kinds of batteries
together — although they may look
similar, different batteries may have
different voltages.
• Make sure that the plus and minus ends
of each battery match the indications in
the battery compartment.
7 m
6
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
• You can control this recorder using the
remote sensor of another Pioneer
component via the CONTROL IN jack on
the rear panel. See Rear panel
connections on page 14 for more
information.
The following table shows older Pioneer DVD
recorders’ limited compatibility with DVD-
RW ver. 1.2 discs.
Model
Playable
Recordable
Yes*1,2,3
DVR-7000
No
Yes*1
DVR-3100/
DVR-5100H
No
Disc/contentformatplayback
compatibility
*1 Discs should be finalized in this recorder before
playing. Unfinalized VR mode and Video mode discs
may not play.
*2 Cannot read the CPRM information will show in
the display when you load a disc. However, this will not
affect playback.
*3 Copy-once protected disc titles will not play.
Compatible media
• DVD-RW ver. 1.1 / 1x / 1x to 2x, ver. 1.2 /
2x to 4x / 2x to 6x
• DVD-R ver. 2.0 /1x / 1x to 4x /
1x to 8x / 1x to 16x, ver. 2.1 / 1x to 8x / 1x
to 16x
Readable file system
This recorder can play DVDs recorded under
the following file systems : ISO 9660*, UDF
1.02, UDF 1.50, UDF 2.00, UDF 2.01.
* ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. Romeo and
Joliet file systems are both compatible with
this recorder.
• DVD+RW 1x to 2.4x / 1x to 4x / 3.3x to 8x
• DVD+R 1x to 2.4x / 1x to 4x / 1x to 8x / 1x
to 16x
1
• DVD-RAM ver. 2.0 / 2x, ver. 2.1 / 2x / 2x to
3x / 2x to 5x, ver. 2.2 / 2x / 2x to 3x / 2x to 5x
• DVD-R DL ver. 3.0 / 2x to 4x / 2x to 8x
• DVD+R DL 2.4x / 2.4x to 8x
Note that older models of DVD recorders
and DVD writers may reject DVD-RW ver. 1.2
discs and/or corrupt the data on the disc. If
you want to share DVD-RW discs between
this recorder and an older recorder/writer,
we recommend using ver. 1.1 discs.
Note
1 • Depending on the recording technique used, even files recorded in compatible file systems may not play
correctly.
• MP3/WMA files can be played back when recorded onto a DVD that contains no video files and uses the UDF
1.02, UDF 1.50, UDF 2.01 or ISO 9660 file systems.
7
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
HDD/DVD Recording and playback compatibility
This recorder can play and record all widely-used DVD disc types, and additionally provides
HDD functionality. The table below shows some specific compatibility differences between
the different disc types.
DVD
+RW
DVD-
RAM
HDD
DVD-R
DVD-RW
DVD+R
Marks used in this
manual
HDD
DVD (VR)
*1
DVD (Video)
DVD (VR)
*1
DVD (Video)
DVD+R
DVD+RW
DVD-RAM
*2
*13, 16
Logos
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
*3
*3
ꢀ
ꢀ
*3
ꢀ *14
ꢀ
Re-recordable/
Erasable
ꢀ
ꢀ *4
ꢀ
ꢀ *4
ꢀ *4
ꢀ *4
ꢀ
Editing of recorded
programmes
ꢀ *12
ꢀ *12
ꢀ *12
Recording of Copy-
once protected
material
n/a
*5
ꢀ *6
*7
ꢀ *6
ꢀ
*6, 15
ꢀ *8
ꢀ *9
Playback in other
players/recorders
ꢀ
ꢀ
Chase play
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
16:9 and 4:3
programme
recording
ꢀ
*10, 11
ꢀ *11
ꢀ *11
ꢀ *11
Bilingualbroadcast
recording of both
audio channels
*13 Take the disc out of the cartridge before use. Only
Panasonic and Maxell discs have been tested to work
reliably with this recorder. Discs from other makers may
become unusable when recorded or edited.
*14 Erasing a title does not increase the available
recording time, nor increase the number of recordable
titles left.
*15 Must be compatible with DVD+R playback.
*16 Depending on the disc, it may have to be initialized
before it can be recorded (page 122). In this case,
initialization will take about an hour.
Notes to table
*1 Must be initialized for VR mode recording (page 122).
*2 Must be initialized for Video mode recording
(page 122).
*3 Erasable, but free space does not increase.
*4 Cannot erase sections, edit chapters or use playlist
editing.
*5 Must be compatible with DVD-R(VR) playback.
*6 Finalize using this recorder (may not playback in
some units) (page 71).
*7 Must be compatible with DVD-RW(VR) playback.
*8 Must be compatible with DVD+RW playback.
*9 Must be compatible with DVD-RAM playback.
*10 Only when HDD Recording Format is set to Video
Mode Off (page 136).
is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
*11 Only when the recording mode is not set to LPCM.
*12 CPRM-compatible discs only.
8
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
The DVD side of a DualDisc plays in this
product. DVD-Audio content will not play.
Using DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL discs
DVD-R DL (Dual-Layer) and DVD+R DL
(Double-Layer) discs contain two recordable
layers on a single side, giving about 1.8
times the recording capacity of a
conventional single-layer disc. This unit can
record to both DVD-R DL and DVD+R DL
discs.
For more detailed information on the
DualDisc specification, please refer to the
disc manufacturer or disc retailer.
Other disc compatibility
In addition to DVD, this recorder is
compatible with a wide range of disc types
(media) and formats. Playable discs will
generally feature one of the logos on the disc
and/or disc packaging shown below. Note
however that some disc types, such as
recordable CD (and DVD), may be in an
unplayable format — see below for further
compatibility information.
• If you intend to play DVD-R DL (Video
mode) or DVD+R DL discs recorded on
this unit on other DVD recorders/players,
you must finalize them. (Note that some
DVD recorders/players may not play
even finalized DL discs.)
• This logo indicates that the disc is a
DVD-R DL or DVD+R DL disc:
Audio CD
CD-R
CD-RW
Video CD
Super Video CD (Super VCD)
Correct operation has been confirmed for
DL discs:
• DVD-R DL ver. 3.0/2x to 4x
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)
CD-R/-RW compatibility
This recorder cannot record CD-R or CD-RW
discs.
• DVD-R DL ver. 3.0/2x to 8x
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)
That’s
JVC
• Readable formats: CD-Audio, Video CD/
Super VCD, ISO 9660 CD-ROM*
containing MP3, WMA, JPEG or DivX
files
* ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. CD
physical format: Mode1, Mode2 XA Form1.
Romeo and Joliet file systems are both
compatible with this recorder.
• DVD+R DL 2.4x
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)
RICOH
• DVD+R DL 2.4x to 8x
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)
RICOH
• Multi-session playback: Yes (except CD-
Audio and Video CD/Super VCD)
About DualDisc playback
A DualDisc is a new two -sided disc, one side
of which contains DVD content –video,
audio, etc. –while the other side contains
non-DVD content such as digital audio
material.
• Unfinalized disc playback: CD-Audio
only
Compressed audio compatibility
• Compatible media: DVD-ROM,
DVD-R/-RW, DVD+R/+RW, DVD-RAM,
CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, USB
The non-DVD, audio side of the disc is not
compliant with the CD Audio specification
and therefore may not play.
• Compatible formats: MPEG-1 Audio
Layer 3 (MP3), Windows Media Audio
(WMA)
It is possible that when loading or ejecting a
DualDisc, the opposite side to that being
played will be scratched. Scratched discs
may not be playable.
9
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
• Sampling rates: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz or
48 kHz
DivX video compatibility
• Bit-rates: Any (128 kbps or higher
recommended)
• Variable bit-rate (VBR) MP3 playback:
Yes
DivX is a compressed digital video format
created by the DivX video codec from DivX,
®
• VBR WMA playback: No
Inc. This recorder can play DivX video files
burned on CD-R/-RW/-ROM discs. Keeping
the same terminology as DVD-Video,
individual DivX video files are called “Titles”.
When naming files/titles on a CD-R/-RW disc
prior to burning, keep in mind that by default
they will be played in alphabetical order.
• WMA encoder compatibility: Windows
Media Codec 8 (files encoded using
Windows Media Codec 9 may be playable
but some parts of the specification are not
supported; specifically, Pro, Lossless,
Voice and VBR)
1
• DRM (Digital Rights Management) file
®
• Official DivX Certified product.
playback: No
®
• Plays all versions of DivX video
• File extensions: .mp3, .wma (these must
be used for the recorder to recognize
MP3 and WMA files – do not use for
other file types)
®
(including DivX 6) with standard
®
playback of DivX media files.
• File extensions: .avi and .divx (these
must be used for the recorder to
recognize DivX video files). Note that all
files with the .avi extension are recognized
as MPEG4, but not all of these are
• File structure: Up to 99 folders/999 files
(if these limits are exceeded, only files
and folders up to these limits are
playable)
necessarily DivX video files and therefore
may not be playable on this recorder.
WMA (Windows Media™ Audio)
compatibility
This recorder can playback Windows Media
Audio content.
• File structure: Up to 99 folders or 999
files.
DivX, DivX Certified, and associated logos are
trademarks of DivX, Inc. and are used under
license.
WMA is an acronym for Windows Media
Audio and refers to an audio compression
technology developed by Microsoft
Corporation. WMA content can be encoded
by using Windows Media Player for
Windows XP, Windows Media Player 9 or
Windows Media Player 10 series.
Windows Media is a trademark of Microsoft
Corporation.
This product includes technology owned by
Microsoft Corporation and cannot be used or
distributed without a license from Microsoft
Licensing, Inc.
Note
1 DRM (digital rights management) copy protection is a technology designed to prevent unauthorized copying by
restricting playback, etc. of compressed audio files on devices other than the PC (or other recording equipment)
used to record it. For detailed information, please see the instruction manuals or help files that came with your
PC and/or software.
10
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
®
• File extensions: .jpg, .jpeg, .jpe, .jif, .jfif
(must be used for the recorder to
recognize JPEG files – do not use for
other file types)
DivX VOD content
DivX
In order to play DivX VOD (video on demand)
content on this recorder, you first need to
register the recorder with your DivX VOD
content provider. You do this by generating a
DivX VOD registration code, which you
submit to your provider.
• File structure: The recorder can load up
to 99 folders/999 files at one time (if there
are more files/folders that this on the disc
then more can be reloaded)
PC-created disc compatibility
Some DivX VOD content may only be
playable a fixed number of times. When you
load a disc containing this type of DivX VOD
content, the remaining number of plays is
shown on-screen and you then have the
option of playing the disc (thereby using up
one of the remaining plays), or stopping. If
you load a disc that contains expired DivX
VOD content (for example, content that has
zero remaining plays), the message Rental
Expired is displayed.
Discs recorded using a personal computer
may not be playable in this unit due to the
setting of the application software used to
create the disc. In these particular
instances, check with the software publisher
for more detailed information.
Discs recorded in packet write mode (UDF
format) are not compatible with this
recorder.
Check the DVD-R/-RW or CD-R/-RW
software disc boxes for additional
compatibility information.
If your DivX VOD content allows an unlimited
number of plays, then you may load the disc
into your recorder and play the content as
often as you like, and no message will be
displayed.
Dolby Digital
Important
• DivX VOD content is protected by a DRM
system. This restricts playback of
content to specific, registered devices.
• If you load a disc that contains DivX VOD
content not authorized for this recorder,
the message Authorization Error is
displayed and the content will not play.
Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories. “Dolby” and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
DTS
• Resetting the recorder (as described in
Resetting the recorder on page 157) will
not cause you to lose your registration
code.
JPEG file compatibility
• Compatible formats: Baseline JPEG and
EXIF 2.2* still image files
*File format used by digital still cameras
“DTS” and “DTS Digital Out” are registered
trademarks of DTS, Inc.
• Sampling ratio: 4:4:4, 4:2:2, 4:2:0
• Horizontal resolution: 160 to 5120 pixels
• Vertical resolution: 120 to 3840 pixels
• Progressive JPEG compatible: No
11
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
• Do not move the recorder while it is on
(this includes during EPG download
when the display shows EPG).
DVB
The Digital Video Broadcasting Project, or
DVB for short, is a set of open standards for
digital broadcasting, covering terrestrial,
cable and satellite broadcasts.
• Install and use the recorder on a stable,
level surface.
Based around the MPEG-2 coding system,
these open standards ensure that compliant
systems are able to work together,
independent of manufacturer.
• Do not block the rear vent/cooling fan.
• Do not use the recorder in excessively
hot or humid places, or in places that
may be subject to sudden changes in
temperature. Sudden changes in
temperature can cause condensation to
form inside the recorder. This can be a
cause of HDD failure.
DVB is extremely flexible, being able to
deliver virtually any kind of digital content to
the home, including High Definition and
Standard Definition TV, broadband
multimedia content and interactive services.
• While the recorder is switched on
(including during EPG download when
the display shows EPG), do not unplug
from the wall socket or switch the
electricity off from the breaker switch.
DVB is a registered trademark of the DVB Project.
• Do not move the recorder immediately
after switching it off. If you need to move
the recorder, please follow the steps
below:
About the internal hard disk
drive
1 After the message POWER OFF is
shown on the front panel display, wait at
least two minutes.
The internal hard disk drive (HDD) is a fragile
piece of equipment. When used without the
proper care or in the wrong conditions, it is
possible that recorded contents may be
damaged or lost entirely, in some cases
making even normal playback or recording
impossible. Please understand that in the
event of repair or replacement of the HDD or
related components, all your HDD
2 Unplug from the wall socket.
3 Move the recorder.
• If there’s a power failure while the
recorder is on there is a chance that
some data on the HDD will be lost.
• The HDD is very delicate. If used over
time in an improper manner or in an
unsuitable environment, it is possible
that the HDD will fail. Signs of problems
include playback unexpectedly freezing
and noticeable block noise (mosaic) in
the picture. However, sometimes there
will be no warning signs of HDD failure.
If the HDD fails, no playback of recorded
material will be possible. In this case it
will be necessary to replace the HDD
unit.
recordings will be lost.
Please use the recorder following the
guidelines below to protect against possible
HDD failure.
The HDD should not be regarded as a place to
store recordings permanently. We
recommend that you back up your important
recordings onto DVD discs in order to protect
against accidental loss.
Pioneer cannot under any circumstances
accept responsibility for any direct or indirect
loss arising from any inconvenience or loss of
recorded material resulting from HDD failure.
12
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
Optimizing HDD performance
As you record and edit material on the HDD,
the data on the disk becomes fragmented,
eventually affecting the recorder’s
performance. Before this happens, the
recorder will warn you that it is time to
optimize the HDD (which you can do from
the Disc Setup menu; see Optimize HDD on
page 122).
Symbols used in this manual
The following icons are provided to help you
quickly identify which instructions you need
for which kind of disc.
HDD
HDD
DVD
Any type of DVD disc
(recordable or playback
only), finalized or not.
DVD-Video
Commercially produced
DVD, finalized Video mode
DVD-R/-RW.
DVD (Video)
Video mode DVD-R/-RW
(unfinalized)
DVD (VR)
VR mode DVD-R/-RW
DVD+R
DVD+R
DVD+RW
DVD+RW
DVD-RAM
DVD-RAM
CD
Audio CD
Video CD
Video CD
Super VCD
Super VCD
WMA/MP3
WMA or MP3 files
DivX
DivX files
A L L
All of the above
13
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
CChoaptnern2 ections
Rear panel connections
1
2
3
4
5
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
IN
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV 2 (INPUT 1/DECODER)
COAXIAL
HDMI OUT
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
OUTPUT
OUT
5 V 30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV 1 (RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
1
ANTENNA IN (RF IN)/OUT
8
AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector
Connect your TV antenna to the ANTENNA
IN (RF IN) jack. The signal is passed through
to the ANTENNA OUT jack for connection to
your TV.
Audio/video output SCART-type AV
connector for connecting to a TV or other
equipment with a SCART connector. The
video output is switchable between video,
S-video and RGB. See AV1 Out on page 131
for how to set this up.
2
INPUT 3
Stereo analog audio, video and S-video
inputs for connection to a VCR or other
source component.
9
G-LINK™
Use to connect the supplied G-LINK™ cable
to enable GUIDE Plus+® to control an
external satellite receiver, etc.
3
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV
connector
Audio/video input/output SCART-type AV
connector for connecting to a VCR, or other
equipment with a SCART connector. The
input accepts video, S-video and RGB. See
AV2/L1 In on page 132 for how to set this up.
10 CONTROL IN
Use to control this recorder from the remote
sensor of another Pioneer component with a
CONTROL OUT terminal and bearing the
Pioneer ꢀ mark. Connect the CONTROL
OUT of the other component to the
CONTROL IN of this recorder using a mini-
plug cord.
4
HDMI OUT
HDMI output for high quality digital audio
and video.
11 ANTENNA (DIGITAL) IN/OUT
5
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT (COAXIAL)
Connect your DTV antenna to the ANTENNA
(DIGITAL) IN jack. The signal is passed
through to the ANTENNA (DIGITAL) OUT
jack for connection to your TV.
Coaxial digital audio jack for connecting to
an AV amplifier/receiver, Dolby Digital/DTS/
MPEG decoder or other equipment with a
digital input.
12 AC IN – Power inlet
6
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
A high-quality video output for connecting to
a TV or monitor with a component video
input.
7
OUTPUT
Stereo analog audio, video and S-video
outputs for connection to a TV or AV
amplifier/receiver.
14
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
Antenna wall outlet
or indoor antenna
Front panel connections
Antenna wall outlet
On the front panel there is a flip-down cover
that hides more connections.
ANTENNA
IN (RF IN)
ANTENNA
(DIGITAL) IN
Left side:
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
S-VIDEO
DV IN
USB
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
ANTENNA
OUT
13
14
15
13 DV IN
A DV input i.LINK connector, suitable for
connecting a DV camcorder.
To antenna input
14 USB port (Type B)
USB port for connecting a PictBridge-
compatible printer or PC.
TV
Important
15 USB port (Type A)
USB port for connecting a digital camera,
keyboard or other USB device.
• If there is only one antenna outlet on
your wall, use a divider.
• Do not connect a component that can
receive analog signals to the ANTENNA
(DIGITAL) OUT.
Right side:
(
)
INPUT
2
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
L
MONO
R
AUDIO
If your area is not yet served with terrestrial
digital services, connect your antenna’s
output to the ANTENNA IN (RF IN)
16
connector using one of the supplied RF
antenna cables. Next, connect the recorder to
your TV from the ANTENNA OUT connector.
16 INPUT 2
Audio/video input (stereo analog audio;
composite and S-video), especially suitable
for camcorders, game consoles, portable
audio, etc.
Antenna
wall outlet
ANTENNA
IN (RF IN)
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
Connecting a TV antenna
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
This recorder has separate built-in TV tuners
for terrestrial digital and terrestrial analog TV
broadcasts.
ANTENNA
OUT
If you are ready to receive digital broadcasts
now, use one of the supplied RF antenna
cables connect an antenna (either an
antenna wall outlet or indoor antenna) to the
ANTENNA (DIGITAL) IN connector. Next,
connect the other supplied RF antenna
cable to connect an antenna to the
ANTENNA IN (RF IN) connector. Lastly,
connect the recorder to your TV from the
ANTENNA OUT connector.
To antenna input
TV
We strongly recommend using an outdoor
antenna for better broadcast picture quality.
If, however, you want to use an indoor
antenna, use one with a signal amplifier
rated at 5 V, 30 mA and set Aerial Power to
On in the Initial Setup menu (see page 129).
15
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
1
Connect your TV antenna to the
Easy connections
recorder and TV.
The setup described below is a basic setup
that allows you to watch and record TV
programmes, and play discs. Other types of
connections are explained starting on the
following page.
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for
details.
• If you want to incorporate a VCR in your
setup, connect it before the recorder (i.e.,
between the antenna wall outlet and the
antenna input on the recorder).
Important
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to
• These connections use SCART cables
(not supplied). If your TV (or VCR) does
not have a SCART connection, and you
want to use the supplied audio/video
cable, see Using the supplied audio/video
cable below.
connect theAV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector on
this recorder to the SCART AV connector on
your TV.
3
Use another SCART cable to connect the
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV connector to
a SCART AV connector on your VCR.
• The AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector can
output ordinary (composite), S-video or
RGB video, plus stereo analog audio. The
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) connector
accepts ordinary, S-video and RGB video
input, as well as stereo analog audio.
See AV1 Out on page 131 and AV2/L1 In
on page 132 for how to setup these
options.
Tip
• This recorder has a ‘through’ function
which allows you to record a TV
programme from the built-in TV tuner in
this recorder while watching a video
playing on your VCR (To use this feature
when the recorder is in standby, Power
Save must be set to Off — see Power
Save on page 127).
• Before making or changing any rear
panel connections, make sure that all
components are switched off and
unplugged from the wall outlet.
Using other types of audio/
video output
1
If you can’t use the SCART AV connector to
connect your TV to this recorder, there are
standard audio/video output jacks, as well as
an S-video and component video output.
Antenna/cable TV
To antenna input
wall outlet
From antenna output
VCR
From SCART AV
connector
To recorder's
antenna input
Using the supplied audio/video
cable
3
AV2 (INPUT 1/
DECODER)
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
To audio input
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AV1 (RGB) - TV
To video input
TV
2
AUDIO
VIDEO
OUTPUT
OUTPUT
V
R
DIGITAL
2
1
AUDIO OUT
IN
S-VIDEO
To SCART AV
connector
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
16
En
TV
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
1
Connect the VIDEO OUTPUT jack to a
2
Connect the AUDIO OUTPUT jacks to
video input on your TV.
Use the yellow jack of the supplied audio/
the corresponding audio inputs on your
TV.
video cable for the video connection.
You can use the supplied audio/video cable,
leaving the yellow video plug disconnected.
Make sure you match up the left and right
outputs with their corresponding inputs for
correct stereo sound.
2
Connect the AUDIO OUTPUT jacks to
the corresponding audio inputs on your TV.
Use the red and white jacks of the supplied
audio/video cable for the audio connection.
Make sure you match up the left and right
outputs with their corresponding inputs for
correct stereo sound.
Connecting to a cable box or
satellite receiver
Using the S-video or component
video output
If you have a cable box or satellite receiver
with a built-in decoder, connect it to this
recorder and your TV as shown on this
To component video input
1
page. If you are using a separate decoder
box for your cable/satellite TV, set up
following the instructions on the next page.
To video input
To audio input
Using the setup on this page you can:
2
TV
• Record any channel by selecting it on
the cable box, satellite receiver or digital
terrestrial receiver.
1
AUDIO
OUTPUT
S-VIDEO
OUTPUT
AUDIO
VIDEO
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
• Change channels and set timer
recordings on the external receiver using
the GUIDE Plus+® system (via the
G-LINK™ cable, and after setting up).
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
1
Connect the S-video or component
Important
video output to a similar input on your
TV.
For an S-video connection, use an S-video
cable (not supplied) to connect the S-VIDEO
OUTPUT jack to an S-video input on your TV.
• Do not connect this recorder to your TV
‘through’ your VCR, satellite receiver or
other component. Always connect each
component directly to your TV or AV
amplifier/receiver.
For a component video connection, use a
component video cable (not supplied) to
connect the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
jacks to a component video input on your TV.
• When using the GUIDE Plus+ system to
make a timer recording from an external
receiver, make sure that the external
receiver is switched on.
See also Component Video Out on page 131
for how to set up the component video
output for use with a progressive scan-
compatible TV.
Note
1 The diagram shows SCART video connections, but you can alternatively use any of the other audio/video
connections.
17
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
Position the IR transmitter end of the
G-LINK™ cable so that the IR receiver on
your cable/satellite receiver will pick up the
control signals (see diagram).
1
Satellite dish/
antenna/cable TV
wall outlet
To antenna input
From antenna output
O
Cable/Satellite
receiver
From SCART AV
connector
S-VIDEO
INPUT
3
AV 2 (INPUT 1/DECODER)
G-LINK
IN
OUTPUT
CONTROL
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
3
To recorder's
antenna input
AV2 (INPUT 1/
DECODER)
4
G-LINK cable
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
See the manual that came with your cable/
satellite receiver if you’re not sure where the
IR receiver is on the front panel.
G-LINK
IN
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AV1 (RGB) - TV
Alternatively, experiment with the remote
control, operating it from very close range
until you find the place where the receiver
responds.
2
To SCART AV
connector
Tip
• This recorder has a ‘through’ function
which allows you to record a TV
TV
1
Connect RF antenna cables as shown.
programme from the built-in TV tuner in
this recorder while watching a video
playing on your VCR (To use this feature
when the recorder is in standby, Power
Save must be set to Off — see Power
Save on page 127).
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for
more on RF antenna connections, including
from this recorder to your TV.
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to
connect the AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector
to a SCART AV connector on your TV.
This enables you to watch discs.
Connecting an external
decoder box (1)
3
Use another SCART cable to connect
the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV
connector to a SCART AV connector on
your cable box/satellite receiver.
This enables you to record scrambled TV
channels.
If you have an external, dedicated decoder
box for your satellite or cable TV system, use
the setup described on this page. See above
for how to connect the G-LINK™ cable.
4
Plug the supplied G-LINK™ cable to
the G-LINK™ jack.
Important
This enables you to control the tuner in the
external receiver using the GUIDE Plus+®
system.
• Do not connect your decoder box directly
to this recorder.
• Information from the decoder (for
example, relating to pay TV services), is
only viewable when this recorder is off
(in standby).
• For timer recording to work properly on
this recorder, the VCR/satellite receiver/
cable box must also be switched on
during recording.
18
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
• It is not possible to watch one TV
programme and record another using
this setup.
Connecting an external
decoder box (2)
If you only have a decoder, connect it to this
recorder and your TV as shown on this
page.
SCART AV
connection
1
Antenna/cable TV
wall outlet
1
2
To antenna input
Using the setup on this page you can:
• Record scrambled channels received
using the recorder’s built-in analog TV
tuner.
VCR/Satellite receiver
/Cable box
Decoder
From SCART AV
connector
3
AV2 (INPUT 1/
DECODER)
Important
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
IN
• Do not connect this recorder ‘through’
your VCR, satellite receiver or cable box.
Always connect each component
directly to your TV or AV amplifier/
receiver.
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
HDMI OUT
COAXIAL
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
P
B
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AV1 (RGB) - TV
4
Decoder
From SCART AV
connector
To SCART AV
connector
3
TV
AV2 (INPUT 1/
DECODER)
1
Connect the cable from the antenna/
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
COAXIAL
HDMI OUT
cable TV outlet to the antenna input on
your VCR/satellite receiver/cable box.
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
PB
PR
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AV1 (RGB) - TV
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to
connect your decoder to your VCR/
satellite receiver/cable box.
2
See the manual for your decoder box for
more detailed instructions.
3
Use a SCART cable to connect your
To SCART AV
connector
VCR/satellite receiver/cable box to the
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV connector
on this recorder.
TV
4
Use a SCART cable to connect the AV1
1
Connect your TV antenna to the
(RGB)-TV AV connector to your TV.
recorder and TV.
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for
details.
Note
1 In order to use this setup, you will need to make the following settings from the Initial Setup menu:
• Set the AV2/L1 In setting to Decoder from the Initial Setup menu (see AV2/L1 In on page 132).
• From the Manual CH Setting screen, set the Decoder setting for the scrambled channels to On (see Manual
CH Setting on page 130).
19
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
connect the AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector
to a SCART AV connector on your TV.
This enables you to watch discs.
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
COAXIAL
HDMI OUT
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
AV
1
(RGB) – TV
EO
AUDIO/VIDEO
OUTPUT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
3
Use another SCART cable to connect
the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV
connector to a SCART AV connector on
your decoder box.
3
2
To audio/video input
To digital input
This enables you to record scrambled TV
channels.
From video
output
AV amp/
receiver
4
Connecting to an AV
amplifier/receiver
To video input
To enjoy multichannel surround sound you
need to connect this recorder to an AV
amplifier/receiver using the digital coaxial
output.
TV
1
Connect your TV antenna to the
recorder and TV.
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for
In addition to a digital connection, we
recommend also connecting using the
stereo analog connection for compatibility
with all discs and sources.
details.
This enables you to watch and record TV
channels.
You’ll probably also want to connect a video
output to your AV amplifier/receiver. Use the
ordinary video output (as shown here), or the
S-video output.
2
Connect the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT
(COAXIAL) jack on this recorder to a
coaxial digital input on your AV
amplifier/receiver.
Important
This enables you to listen to multichannel
• Noise may be output from your speakers
if the recorder is not set up to work with
your AV amplifier/receiver properly (see
Audio Out on page 133).
surround sound.
3
Connect the analog AUDIO OUTPUT
and VIDEO OUTPUT jacks on this recorder
to an analog audio and video input on
your AV amplifier/receiver.
• When watching D.TV only linear PCM
audio is output from the coaxial digital
out jack.
4
Connect the AV amplifier/receiver’s
video output to a video input on your TV.
• Do not connect this recorder to your TV
‘through’ your VCR using A/V cables.
Always connect it directly to your TV.
Connecting using HDMI
1
If you have an HDMI or DVI-equipped
2
monitor or display , you can connect it to
this recorder using an HDMI cable (not
supplied).
Note
1 Depending on the component you have connected, using a DVI connection may result in unreliable signal
transfers.
2 The pixel resolution of this recorder’s HDMI video output is (according to TV format): NTSC (720 x 480i/p, 1280
x 720p, 1920 x 1080i/p) and PAL (720 x 576i/p, 1280 x 720p, 1920 x 1080i/p). If your display is not compatible with
these resolutions the picture may not be correctly reproduced.
20
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
The HDMI connector outputs
uncompressed digital video, as well as
almost every kind of digital audio.
HDMI adaptor cable. A DVI to HDCP
connection, however, does not support
audio. Consult your local audio dealer for
more information.
1
Use an HDMI cable to connect the
• The HDMI connection is compatible with
32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 96 kHz, 16 bit/
20 bit/24 bit 2-channel linear PCM
signals, as well as Dolby Digital, DTS and
MPEG audio bitstream.
HDMI OUT connector on this recorder to
an HDMI connector on an HDMI-
compatible display.
• If your connected component is only
compatible with Linear PCM, the signal
is output as Linear PCM (DTS audio is
not output).
H
T
I
D
o
N
M
HD
I
MI
i
nput
HDMI-compatible display
• If you have connected to a Pioneer
plasma display, please select the HDMI
setup on the display (refer to the
HDMI
OUT
supplied manual for more on this).
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
ANTENNA
IN
ITAL
O OUT
S-VIDEO
AC IN
INPUT
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)
2
I
HDMI OUT
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)
IN
G-LINK
IN
OUT
5
OUTPUT
OUT
V
30 mA
CONTROL
Y
PB
PR
AV
1
(RGB)
–
TV
About HDMI
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia
Interface) supports both video and audio on
a single digital connection for use with DVD
players and recorders, DTV, set-top boxes,
and other AV devices. HDMI was developed
to provide the technologies of High-
bandwidth Digital Content Protection
(HDCP) as well as Digital Visual Interface
(DVI) in one specification. HDCP is used to
protect digital content transmitted and
received by DVI-compliant displays.
• The arrow on the cable connector body
should be face down for correct
alignment with the connector on the
recorder.
When connected to an HDMI component or
HDCP-compatible DVI component, the
HDMI indicator lights.
HDMI has the capability to support
HDMI setup is generally automatic. There
are however settings you can change if you
need to. See HDMI Output (only available
when an HDMI device is connected) on
page 138 for more information. Note that the
HDMI settings remain in effect until you
change them, or connect a new HDMI
component.
standard, enhanced, or high-definition video
plus standard to multi-channel surround-
sound audio. HDMI features include
uncompressed digital video, a bandwidth of
up to five gigabits per second (Dual Link),
one connector (instead of several cables and
connectors), and communication between
the AV source and AV devices such as DTVs.
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition
Multimedia Interface are trademarks or
registered trademarks of HDMI licensing LLC.
Important
• An HDMI connection can only be made
with DVI-equipped components
compatible with both DVI and High-
bandwidth Digital Content Protection
(HDCP). If you choose to connect to a
DVI connector, you will need a DVI to
21
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
Connecting a DV camcorder
Connecting other AV sources
You can connect a DV camcorder or DVD
recorder with DV output to the front panel
DV IN jack.
Connecting a VCR or analog
camcorder
HDD/DVD
OPEN/CLOSE
Important
A.TV
D.TV
PLTV
DivX
COPY
HDMI
COMMON INTERFACE
STANDBY/ON
DV IN
USB
INPUT
2
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
L(MONO)
R
AUDIO
REC
ONE TOUCH
COPY
STOP REC
• This jack is for connection to DV
equipment only. It is not compatible with
digital satellite receivers or D-VHS video
decks.
INPUT
CH
A.TV/D.TV
SELECT
AUDIO/VIDEO
OUTPUT
AUDIO/VIDEO
INPUT
(Rear panel)
(Front panel)
HDD/DVD
OPEN/CLOSE
A.TV
D.TV
PLTV
DivX
COPY
HDMI
COMMON INTERFACE
STANDBY/ON
DV IN
USB
INPUT
2
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
L(MONO)
R
AUDIO
REC
ONE TOUCH
COPY
STOP REC
INPUT
SELECT
CH
A.TV/D.TV
1
2
DV
IN
Analog camcorder
To audio/video input
From audio/video output
From DV output
VCR
DV camcorder
1
Connect a set of audio and video
• Use a DV cable (not supplied) to
connect the DV jack of your DV
camcorder to the front panel DV IN
jack of this recorder.
inputs of your VCR or camcorder to a set
of outputs on this recorder.
This enables you to record from this recorder
to your VCR or camcorder.
• You can use standard video or S-video
cables for the video connection.
Connecting a USB device
Using the USB ports on the front of the
recorder you can connect USB devices such
as digital cameras, printers, keyboards and
PCs. Please also see the instructions that
came with the device you want to connect
before using.
• Alternatively, you can use the AV2
(INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART connector
for audio/video input and output with
just one SCART cable.
2
Connect a set of audio and video
outputs of your VCR or camcorder to a
set of inputs on this recorder.
This enables you to record tapes from your
VCR or camcorder.
H
D
D
/
D
V
D
OPEN/CLOSE
A.TV
D.TV
PLTV
DivX
COPY
HDMI
COMMON INTERFACE
STANDBY/ON
D
V
I
N
USB
INPUT
2
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
L(MONO)
R
AUDIO
REC
ONE TOUCH
COPY
STOP REC
INPUT
SELECT
CH
A.TV/D.TV
USB
(Type B)
USB
(Type A)
• You can use standard video or S-video
cables for the video connection.
USB
USB
• The front panel connections make
convenient connections for a camcorder
input.
Digital Camera
PictBridge-compatible
Printer
• When connecting an external AV source
that only supports monaural sound, only
insert the left (white) audio jack to this
device. Doing so will allow the same
sound track to be recorded to both
channels. You must connect to the
INPUT 2 jack on the front panel.
Keyboard
PC
22
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connections
02
• In the event of unreliable operation with
the hub, we recommend plugging the
device directly into the recorder’s USB
port.
Important
• Some USB devices may not work with
this recorder.
• Operation may become unreliable if too
many devices are connected to the hub.
In this case, try unplugging some
devices.
• When connecting a PC to this unit, make
sure the power is turned off on both the
PC and this unit when you connect them
via USB.
• If the power delivered through a hub is
insufficient for the devices connected,
communication can become unreliable.
In this case, disconnect one or more
devices then perform a USB restart. (See
Restart USB Device on page 140.)
• We recommend connecting USB
devices when this recorder is switched
off (in standby).
JPEG file storage devices
• Digital still camera
• Memory card reader (any type of
memory card)
Using a USB printer
• Use a PictBridge-compatible printer.
• USB memory
The Mass Storage Class (MSC) device
should be FAT-compatible. Note that if the
device is partitioned, this recorder may not
recognize it.
Using a USB keyboard
• Do not use a PS/2 keyboard connected
using a PS/2-USB adapter.
Using a PC
The Picture Transfer Protocol (PTP) can be
used to transfer up to a maximum of 4000
files.
• Note that you can connect a PC to this
device via USB to copy WMA and MP3
files. For more information, see Connect
PC on page 109. To use Connect PC with
this device, your PC must run either the
Windows XP Home Edition (SP2) or
Windows XP Professional (SP2)
operating system and be able to run
Windows Media Player 10. Even if your
PC can run Windows Media Player 10,
we cannot guarantee that it will function
properly with this device. For more
details see the ‘Help’ section of Windows
Media Player 10.
WMA/MP3 file storage devices
• Memory card reader (any type of
memory card)
• USB memory
• PC (Use Connect PC function)
The Mass Storage Class (MSC) device
should be FAT-compatible. Note that if the
device is partitioned, this recorder may not
recognize it.
Note that although multi-slot card readers
can be used, the recorder will only recognize
the first card inserted. To read another card,
remove all the cards and insert the card to be
read again.
Plugging in
After checking all the connections, plug in
the recorder.
Using a USB hub
• Use a hub compatible with USB 1.1 and/
•
Use the supplied power cable to
connect this recorder to a power outlet.
or 2.0.
• Use an independently powered hub (bus
powered hubs may not work reliably).
23
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
03
CChaoptnert3rols and displays
Front panel
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
HDD/DVD
COPY
OPEN/CLOSE
A.TV
D.TV
PLTV
DivX
HDMI
COMMON INTERFACE
STANDBY/ON
DV IN
USB
INPUT
2
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
L(MONO)
R
AUDIO
REC
ONE TOUCH
COPY
STOP REC
INPUT
SELECT
CH
A.TV/D.TV
8
9
10
11
9
12
1
A.TV indicator
Lights when analog TV is selected.
4
HDD/DVD indicator
Indicator lights blue when the hard disk
(HDD) is selected; orange when the DVD
drive is selected.
D.TV indicator
Lights when digital TV is selected.
5
ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE
Press to open/close the disc tray.
HDMI indicator
PLTV indicator
Lights during recording started using
the Pause Live TV feature.
6
Lights when this recorder is connected to
HDMI (HDCP) compatible component.
DivX indicator
Lights during DivX playback.
7
Front panel display and IR remote
sensor
COPY indicator
Lights when copying is underway.
See Display on page 26 for details.
8
ꢂ STANDBY/ON
Press to switch the recorder on/into standby.
Front panel inputs
2
HDD/DVD
Press to switch between HDD and DVD for
recording and playback.
9
See Front panel connections on page 15 for
more information on these.
3
Disc tray
10 COMMON INTERFACE slot
Slot for CA module and smart card used to
decode scrambled D.TV channels. See
Common Interface on page 25.
24
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
03
11 ꢃ
Common Interface
Press to start or restart playback.
To receive scrambled D.TV channels you will
need a CA module and smart card provided
by your service provider.
ꢄ
Press to stop playback.
ꢀ STOP REC
Press to stop recording.
Different CA modules support different
encryption systems. This recorder is
designed to work with modules that support
the DVB standard. Contact your service
provider to obtain the right kind of CA
module.
ONE TOUCH COPY
Press to start One Touch Copy of the
currently playing title to DVD or the
HDD.
Note that neither CA modules nor smart
cards are supplied or sold by Pioneer.
CH +/–
Use to change channels, skip chapters/
tracks, etc.
Inserting a CA module
The Common Interface card slot is located
on the front panel of the recorder.
INPUT SELECT
Press to change the input used for
recording.
•
Insert the CA module into the card
A.TV/D.TV
slot as far as it will go.
Switches between analog TV antenna
input and digital TV antenna input. The
A.TV and D.TV indicators show which is
selected.
12 ꢀ REC
Press to start recording. Press repeatedly to
set the recording time in 30 minute blocks.
The Common Interface card slot accepts
Type I and Type II PC Cards (PCMCIA cards).
25
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
Display
03
1
2
3
4
5
L
R
P
8
7
6
1
ꢃ
LP/SLP
Lights during playback; blinks when
Lights when the recording mode is set to
playback is paused.
LP (long play) or SLP (super-long play).
2
ꢀ
EP/SEP
Lights when copying.
Lights when the recording mode is set to
EP (extended play) or SEP (super-
extended play).
3
ꢀ
Lights during recording; blinks when
recording is paused.
MN
Lights when the recording mode is set to
MN (manual recording level) mode.
4
(page 68)
Lights when a timer recording has been
set. (Indicator blinks if the timer has
been set to DVD but there isn’t a
recordable disc loaded, or the timer has
been set to record to the HDD but the
HDD is not recordable.)
6
7
Character display
R/RW
Lights when a recordable DVD-R or DVD-RW
disc is loaded.
8
PL (page 89)
Lights when a VR mode disc is loaded
and the recorder is in Play List mode.
NTSC
Lights when the video output signal
format is NTSC.
2 3 (page 139)
(page 132)
Indicates which channels of a bilingual
broadcast are recorded.
Shows the remote control mode (if
nothing is displayed, the remote control
mode is 1).
V
(page 131)
Lights when the component video output
is set to progressive scan.
Lights when an unfinalized Video mode
disc is loaded.
VPS/PDC (page 68)
Lights when receiving a VPS/PDC
broadcast during a VPS/PDC-enabled
timer recording.
5
Recording quality indicators (page 64)
XP
Lights when the recording mode is set to
XP (high quality).
SP
Lights when the recording mode is set to
SP (standard play).
26
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
Remote control
03
ꢈ ꢉ (page 79)
Press to start reverse or forward
scanning. Press again to change the
speed.
STANDBY/ON
HDD/DVD
1
2
12
ꢊ/ꢋ ꢌ/ꢍ (page 79)
PREV
PAUSE
STOP
NEXT
While paused, press and hold to start
slow-motion playback. Press repeatedly
to change the playback speed.
PLAY
13
14
HELP
REC
INFO
3
While paused, press to advance a single
frame in either direction.
TOP MENU
HOME MENU
DISC
NAVIGATOR
GUIDE
4
5
15
16
CHANNEL
+
CM BACK
When GUIDE Plus+® is displayed, use
to display the previous/next day.
ENTER
–
CHANNEL
CM SKIP
3
HELP
A.TV/D.TV
RETURN/EXIT
Press for help on how to use the current GUI
screen.
6
7
17
18
4
DISC NAVIGATOR (page 78, 89)/
PAUSE
LIVE TV
TIMER
REC
ONE TOUCH
REC MODE
COPY
TOP MENU (page 75)
8
9
19
20
21
22
AUDIO
SUBTITLE
ABC
ANGLE INPUT SELECT
Press to display the Disc Navigator screen,
or the top menu if a DVD-Video or finalized
DVD-R/-RW (Video) disc is loaded.
DEF
MNO
WXYZ
MENU
GHI
JKL
DISPLAY
10
11
5
ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ and ENTER (Smart Jog)
Used to navigate all on-screen displays.
Rotate the Smart Jog to move the cursor
up or down. Press ENTER to select the
currently highlighted option.
PQRS
TUV
+
CLEAR CLEAR
TV CONTROL
TEXT
23
24
INPUT SELECT CHANNEL VOLUME
TV/DVD
When using the Smart Jog, turn it lighty
to avoid pressing down on the cursor
keys.
OPEN
While watching D.TV press ENTER to
display the Channel List screen.
1
ꢂ STANDBY/ON
Press to switch the recorder on/into standby.
Rotate the Smart Jog when playback is
paused to do a frame-by-frame search
back/forward.
2
ꢃ PLAY (page 74)
Press to start playback.
ꢅ PAUSE
Press to pause playback or recording.
CM BACK (commercial back)
Turn the Smart Jog counter-clockwise
during playback to skip progressively
backward through the video playing.
ꢄ STOP (page 74)
Press to stop playback.
ꢆ PREV ꢇ NEXT
CM SKIP (commercial skip)
Press to skip to the previous or next title/
chapter/track/folder; or to display the
previous or next menu page.
Turn the Smart Jog clockwise during
playback to skip progressively forward
through the video playing.
When GUIDE Plus+® is displayed, use
to display the previous/next page.
CHANNEL +/– (page 61)
While stopped, turn the Smart Jog to
change the channel of the built-in TV
tuner.
27
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
03
6
A.TV/D.TV
13 Recording controls (page 64)
Press to switch between analog TV antenna
input and digital TV antenna input. The A.TV
and D.TV indicators on the front panel show
which is selected.
ꢀ REC
Press to start recording. Press
repeatedly to set the recording time in
blocks of 30 mins.
7
Colour buttons
(RED, GREEN, YELLOW, BLUE)
When the red action button is visible in a
GUIDE Plus+® screen, use for One-
Button-Record.
Use when an EPG screen is displayed or
when tuned to a data channel of a digital
broadcast. The function of each button will
be described on-screen, and changes
depending on the screen being displayed.
ꢀ STOP REC
Press to stop recording.
14 INFO
8
PAUSE LIVE TV (page 66)
While watching D.TV, press to display the
information banner.
Press to start recording the current TV
channel, but with playback paused,
effectively pausing the broadcast.
Press to see additional information for the
highlighted item in the EPG.
9
AUDIO (page 62, 63, 82, 83)
15 GUIDE
Press to change the audio language or
channel. (When the recorder is stopped,
press to change the tuner audio.)
Press to display the EPG screen; press again
to exit.
16 HOME MENU
Press to display the Home Menu, from
which you can navigate all the functions of
the recorder.
SUBTITLE (page 82)
Press to display/change the subtitles
included in multilingual DVD-Video
discs.
17 RETURN/EXIT
Press to go back one level in the on-screen
menu or display.
While watching D.TV, press to change
the D.TV subtitles.
Also press to exit the MHEG application.
ANGLE (page 83)
Press to switch camera angles on discs
with multi-angle scenes.
18 TIMER REC (page 38, 68)
Press to set a timer recording.
REC MODE (page 64)
10 Number buttons, CLEAR, +
Press repeatedly to change the
recording mode (picture quality).
Use the number buttons for track/chapter/
title selection; channel selection, and so on.
The same buttons can also be used to enter
names for titles, discs and so on.
19 ONE TOUCH COPY (page 100)
Press to start One Touch Copy of the
currently playing title to DVD or the HDD.
Use CLEAR to clear an entry and start again.
20 INPUT SELECT (page 70)
Press to change the input to use for
recording.
11 TV CONTROL buttons (page 143)
After setting up, use these controls to
control your TV.
21 MENU (page 75)
12 HDD/DVD (page 64)
Press to display the disc menu if a DVD-
Video, finalized DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or
finalized DVD+R/+RW disc is loaded.
Press to select the hard disk (HDD) or DVD
for recording and playback.
When in the GUIDE Plus+® system, use to
jump directly to the Menu bar.
28
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
03
22 DISPLAY (page 84)
Displays/changes the on-screen information
displays.
23 TEXT (page 62, 63)
Press to display Teletext information (in
European countries except the UK) or to
start the MHEG application display (UK only)
if available during digital broadcasts.
24 TV/DVD
Press to switch between ‘TV mode’, in which
you get the picture and sound from the TV’s
tuner, and ‘DVD mode’, in which you get
picture and sound from the recorder’s tuner
(or an external input).
29
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
Chapter 4
Getting started
Switching on and setting up
ENTER
4
Start the Setup Navigator.
When you switch the recorder on for the first
time, you can make several basic settings
using the Setup Navigator feature. This takes
you through setting the clock, the internal TV
tuner and the video output.
k
Complete this setup before you
t
start using your recorder.
e
P
Start
Cancel
p
Please use the Initial Setup if you
want to make more detailed settings.
If you’re using the recorder for the first time,
we strongly recommend you use the Setup
Navigator before starting to use the
recorder.
• If you don’t want to use the Setup
Navigator, press ꢂ to select Cancel,
then press ENTER to exit the Setup
Navigator.
1
Switch on your TV and set the video
input to this recorder.
ENTER
STANDBY/ON
5
Select an Aerial Power
ꢂ
2
Switch on the recorder.
1
setting for the built-in digital tuner.
• On: power is always supplied to the
connected aerial, whether the recorder
is on or in standby.
When you switch on for the first time, your
TV should display the Setup Navigator
screen (If the Setup Navigator doesn’t
appear, you can also access it from the
Initial Setup menu; see page 127).
• Auto: power is only supplied when this
recorder is on.
• If this recorder is connected to a
compatible TV using a fully-wired 21-pin
SCART cable, the recorder will take a few
seconds to download country, TV screen
size and language information. (Check
the manual that came with your TV for
compatibility information.)
• Off: power is never supplied to the
aerial.
ENTER
6
Select ‘Auto Scan’ to start
scanning for D.TV channels.
• Select Do not set if you want to skip
D.TV channel setup (because they have
already been set up, for example), then
skip to step 8 below.
ENTER
3
Choose a language (then
press ENTER).
Initial Setup
ENTER
Basic
Clock Language
Input
Powe
Tuner
7
Select your country.
Video In/ Out
Audio In
Audio Out
Language
Recording
Playback
HELP
The recorder starts scanning for new
channels. After the scan is complete the
recorder will let you know how many new
channels were found.
Setup
• The country setting will apply to both the
digital and analog TV tuners.
Note
1 If the recorder does not accept the On or Auto setting (the highlight jumps back to Off), check that the antenna
is properly connected and that it is not shorted, then try making the setting again.
30
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
• The clock will also be set automatically
here if D.TV channels are found.
•
Downloading channels from your TV
Use the Download from TV option to
download all the channels that your TV is
tuned to.
• If no new channels were found a
message appears asking if you want to
scan again. Check the aerial connection
before selecting Yes. (If you select No,
skip to step 8 below.)
Downloading
Pr 5
32/99
Cancel
ENTER
ENTER
8
Select the analog TV (A.TV)
9
Select ‘Auto’ for automatic
Auto Channel Setting (‘Auto Scan’ or
‘Download from TV’), or ‘Do not set’.
time setting, or ‘Manual’ to set the clock
manually.
If the clock was already set from a D.TV
k
AutoChannel Setting
channel in step 6, this step is skipped.
e
P
AutoScan
Download from TV
k
ClockSetting
p Do not Set
er
P
Auto
• Select Do not set if you want to skip
channel setup (because they have
already been set up, for example).
Manual
•
Auto clock setting
Some TV channels broadcast time
signals together with the programme.
This recorder can use these signals to
set the clock automatically.
• You can only use the Download from
TV feature if this recorder is connected
to your TV using a fully-wired 21-pin
SCART cable via the AV1 (RGB)-TV
connector, and if your TV supports this
function (check your TV’s instruction
manual for more details).
Set ‘Clock Set CH‘ to the channel
preset number that broadcasts a time
signal, then move the cursor down to
‘Start’ and press ENTER.
ENTER
k
AutoClock Setting
•
•
Select your country.
Date
––
––
/
:
––
––
/
––––
e
Time
P
k
Country Selection
p
Clock Set CH
Pr
1
t
eCountry
P
Start
UK
The recorder takes a short while to set
the time. After you see that it’s set, select
Next to proceed.
Auto-tuning channels
The Auto Scan option automatically scans
and sets the channel presets.
k
AutoClock Setting
Date
MON 01
11
/
01
20
/
2007
e
Time
Tuning
:
P
p
Clock Set CH
Pr
1
32/99
Start
Next
Cancel
If the time could not be set
automatically, press RETURN/EXIT to go
back to the previous screen and select
Manual.
31
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
•
Manual clock setting
ENTER
If no stations in your area are
broadcasting time signals, you can set
the clock manually.
10
Select the EPG (Electronic
Programme Guide) type to use.
• GUIDE Plus+: Use the Gemstar GUIDE
Plus+ EPG (see also Setting up the
GUIDE Plus+® system on page 33 and
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic
programme guide on page 37).
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to set your
time zone.
You can set this by selecting a city or a
time relative to GMT.
1/2
k
Manual Clock Setting
• Digital EPG: Use the SI EPG
(programme information broadcast
together with digital channels).
Time Zone
England
London
e
P
p Summer Time
Off
• If no channels were found when
scanning for digital TV channels then
this screen does not appear and the EPG
is set according to the country set in step
7 above.
Press ꢂthen use the ꢃ/ꢀbuttons to
select ‘On’ or ‘Off’ for summer time,
then press ENTER.
Select On if you are currently using
summer time.
ENTER
11
Select the TV screen type,
1/2
k
Manual Clock Setting
‘Wide (16:9)’ or ‘Standard (4:3)’.
Time Zone
England
London
e
k
TVScreen Size
P
p Summer Time
On
er
P
Wide (16:9)
Standard (4:3)
p Navigator
Set the date (day/month/year) and
time, then press ENTER to make all
the settings.
ENTER
12
Select whether or not your TV
is compatible with progressive scan
video.
2/2
k
Manual Clock Setting
Date
e
MON 01
00
/
:
01
00
/
2007
k
Progressive
P
Time
p
Time Zone
er
P
Compatible
England
London
Not Compatible
p Don't Know
Summer Time
On
• Note that progressive scan video is only
output through the AV1 (RGB)-TV
connector and the component video
outputs.
• Use the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to change the
value in the highlighted field.
• Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to move from one
field to another.
ENTER
13
Press to continue after reading
• You can go back to the previous screen
in the Setup Navigator by pressing
RETURN/EXIT.
the HDD caution.
k Inthe event of HDD failure, recordings may
be lost or normal playback/recording may
not be possible.
e
As recordings might be lost in case of a HDD
failure, we recommend to use the HDD only
P
as temporary storage media.
p
Please copy recordings you want to keep
to recordable DVD.
Press ENTER to continue.
32
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®
system
ENTER
14
Select ‘Finish Setup’ to exit
the Setup Navigator, or ‘Go Back’ if you
want to start again.
This section is only applicable if you chose to
use the GUIDE Plus+ system as the EPG type
in step 10 of the Setup Navigator above.
k
Setting
Setupis complete!
e
The GUIDE Plus+® system is a free,
interactive on-screen television
Finish Setup
Go Back
p
programming guide. The system offers
programme listings for all major channels,
one-touch recording, search by genre,
recommendations according to your profile
and more.
That completes basic setup using the Setup
Navigator.
• If there are blank channels with no
station, you can set these to skip using
the manual channel setting. See Manual
CH Setting on page 130.
For the GUIDE Plus+ system to function
correctly, it is important that you set the
language and country correctly in the Setup
Navigator, and that you have performed a
scan for available channels, as these are all
used by the GUIDE Plus+ system. If any of
these things are not yet set, please run the
Setup Navigator first (see Switching on and
setting up on page 30).
For users receiving digital
broadcast services
This unit can set its internal clock
automatically from digital broadcasts.
However, depending on the broadcaster, the
clock information received may not be
accurate.
TV listings information is received via ‘host
channels’. In order to receive the correct TV
listings information for your country or
region you need to set up the GUIDE Plus+
system and ‘download’ the TV listings
information. The initial download can take
up to 24 hours, but once this is done, all
future updates are automatic.
Use the following procedure (while the
recorder is not recording) to set the clock
manually.
HOME MENU
1
Press HOME MENU.
ENTER
2
Select ’Initial Setup’ > ‘Basic’ >
GUIDE
1
Display the GUIDE Plus+ setup
‘Clock Setting’.
3
menu.
Highlight the time setting.
ENTER
4
Press to display the manual clock
setting screen.
Set the correct time.
5
Return to automatic clock setting
• To return to the automatic clock setting,
follow the instructions for ‘Replace
Channels’ (page 128).
The language and country settings are
already set to whatever you selected in the
Setup Navigator.
33
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
4
If you are using an external receiver
ENTER
(such as a satellite receiver) with the
supplied G-LINK cable, complete this
step, otherwise jump to step 5 below.
2
Highlight ‘Postal Code’.
• See Connecting to a cable box or satellite
receiver on page 17 for more on using the
supplied G-LINK cable.
ENTER
3
Enter your postal
code.
• Select External Receiver 1, 2 or 3, then
press ENTER. (If you have just one
external receiver, use External Receiver
1. You can add further receivers in 2 and
3 if you need to.)
After pressing ENTER:
• Select your reception method
(Terrestrial, Cable or Satellite).
• Select your provider (if applicable).
• Select the brand of your external
receiver.
• Identify which input your external
receiver is connected to.
The system uses your postal code to identify
which TV listings data is correct for the area
in which you live, so it is important that you
enter it correctly.
After completing these steps the recorder
will try and communicate with your external
receiver and change the channel via the G-
LINK cable. If the channel was successfully
changed, select Yes to confirm.
If the channel did not change, select No. The
GUIDE Plus+ system will try other codes
assigned to your external receiver. If none of
the codes changes the channel
successfully, tune your external receiver to
the host channel for your country (refer to
step 5 below) and leave it on overnight. The
34
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
recorder needs to be in standby; it will wake
up automatically and download new codes
from the host channel. The next day, try this
setup process again:
Country/ Host
Comments
Region
Austria
Belgium
France
Germany
Italy
channels
Eurosport
RTL-TVI
Canal+
Eurosport
MTV
• Press GUIDE to display the GUIDE
Plus+ screen.
Analog only
Analog only
Analog only
• Press ꢁ to highlight the Menu bar, then
use ꢀ to reach the Setup area and
select Setup.
• Continue setting up from the start of this
step again.
Netherlands Eurosport
Spain Tele 5
Switzerland Eurosport
If your external receiver still doesn’t respond
to the G-LINK controller, please call
customer support and report the brand and
model of your external receiver.
UK
ITV, Eurosport ITV is analog only. Use
Eurosport if you are a
SKY subscriber and
you no longer have an
analog terrestrial
See also GUIDE Plus+ FAQ and
troubleshooting on page 48.
5
Identify the host channel for your
antenna.
country.
The TV listings information available in the
GUIDE Plus+ system is distributed
throughout Europe by selected broadcasters
called host channels. It is important that the
host (analog) channel for your country is
correctly identified in order to receive
listings information (EPG download).
• Tune your external receiver to the
appropriate host channel and leave the
receiver on and the recorder in standby
overnight.
C If you use both an external receiver
and this recorder as sources, follow the
instructions above for setting up without
an external receiver. Only if this is
unsuccessful try the external receiver
method.
Follow A, B or C below depending on your
setup:
A If you are not using an external
receiver, this recorder will automatically
scan all channels for the host channel:
About EPG download
• EPG data can only be received when the
recorder is in standby. (When not using the
recorder, therefore, please switch it into
standby.) If you’re using an external receiver,
leave this on when EPG data is downloading.
• Leave the recorder in standby overnight
(do not leave it switched on).
B If you are using an external receiver,
you need to identify the host channel
from the table below:
• If you cannot receive any of the host
channels (see the above table) then you
won’t be able to use the GUIDE Plus+
system. In this case do not set the postal
code (or set Country to Other) in the
GUIDE Plus+ setup screen. (When
GUIDE Plus+ service starts in your area,
set the postal code again.)
If digital broadcasts start in your area,
please set the EPG Type Select setting in
the Initial Setup menu to Digital EPG.
35
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
04
• Even if you can’t use the EPG functions
where you live, you can still set VIDEO
Plus+ recordings and manual
recordings — see Setting a manual
recording on page 45.
• For any channel that you turn ON, the
GUIDE Plus+ system will need to know
how it is received (the source) and on
which programme number. The source
may be the built-in tuner of this recorder,
or an external receiver. The programme
number is the number on which the
channel can be found on its receiving
device/source. The entry in the Editor
screen must match this number for
correct recording of that channel.
• The front panel display shows EPG when
receiving data. If you power on the
recorder during an EPG download, the
download is cancelled.
• EPG data may be received several times
a day. All updates are automatic.
• The above is especially important for the
‘host channel’. Please make sure that
the host channel is always switched ON.
• When downloading EPG data, the
recorder may sound as though it is on.
This is normal.
Checking the downloaded data the
following day
2
Change the programme
numbers as you like.
GUIDE
1
Display the GUIDE Plus+ screen.
Changing the programme numbers allows
you to decide the order in which the
channels change when stepping through
them sequentially. You can do this to group
certain channels together, for example.
Name
BBC1
BBC2
ITV
CH4
CH5
BBC3
ITV2
E4
On/Off Source
Prog. No.
001
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
Off
On
D. TV
D. TV
002
003
004
005
007
006
014
017
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
Ext. Rec. 1
D. TV
You should see a grid filled with channel
logos and TV listings information. Use the
ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to review the list. If you notice
that there are channels missing, or that
there are channels in the list that you don’t
get, go to the Editor screen:
D. TV
D. TV
UKGOL
3
When you’re done, press the BLUE
Action button (Home) to get back to the
GUIDE Plus+ home screen.
• Press ꢁrepeatedly until the Menu bar is
highlighted.
• You can find detailed information on
using the GUIDE Plus+ system in the
following chapter.
• Press ꢀ until Editor is highlighted. The
main area of the screen now shows a list
of channels. Those that are turned ON
are displayed in the grid; those that are
OFF are hidden. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ
buttons to move down the list and turn
channels ON or OFF as necessary.
36
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
Chapter 5
Using the GUIDE Plus+®
electronic programme guide
GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL, INC. AND/
OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES BE LIABLE FOR ANY
AMOUNTS REPRESENTING LOSS OF PROFITS, LOSS
OF BUSINESS, OR INDIRECT, SPECIAL, OR
This chapter is only applicable if the EPG Type
Select setting made in the Setup Navigator (or
the Initial Setup menu) is set to GUIDE Plus+.
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES IN CONNECTION
WITH THE PROVISION OR USE OF ANY
INFORMATION, EQUIPMENT, OR SERVICES
The GUIDE Plus+ system
RELATING TO THE GUIDE PLUS+ SYSTEM.
The GUIDE Plus+® system* is a free,
interactive on-screen television
programming guide. The system provides
programme listings for all major channels,
Using the GUIDE Plus+
system
1
one-touch recording, searching by genre,
All the various features and areas are colour-
recommendations according to your profile
coded for ease of navigation. All screens
and more. The GUIDE Plus+ system is a
(with the exception of some setup screens)
convenient way to find out what’s on right
have the following common elements:
now or during the coming week, by channel
or by genre. The GUIDE Plus+ system also
allows you to automatically set your viewing
and recording selections quickly and easily.
3
4
1
In order to receive the correct TV listings
5
information for your country or region you
need to set up the GUIDE Plus+ system and
‘download’ the TV listings information. If you
6
haven’t already done this, please turn to
Setting up the GUIDE Plus+® system on
page 33 before proceeding.
2
* GUIDE Plus+, SHOWVIEW, VIDEO Plus+,
G-LINK are (1) registered trademarks or
trademarks of, (2) manufactured under
license from and (3) subject of various
international patents and patent applications
owned by, or licensed to, Gemstar-TV Guide
International, Inc. and/or its related affiliates.
1 Video window – Allows you to continue
watching the current programme while
using the GUIDE Plus+ system.
2 Information panels – Display
programme promotions or instructions
on the GUIDE Plus+ system.
3 Action bar – Colour-coded Action
buttons change function depending on
the area.
Legal Notice
GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL, INC. AND/
OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES ARE NOT IN ANY WAY
LIABLE FOR THE ACCURACY OF THE PROGRAMME
SCHEDULE INFORMATION PROVIDED BY THE
GUIDE PLUS+ SYSTEM. IN NO EVENT SHALL
4 Information box – Shows short
programme descriptions or help menus.
Note
1 The GUIDE Plus+ system can’t be used when the Input Line System is set to 525 System (see also Input Line
System on page 127).
37
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
5 Menu bar – Gives access to the various
areas of the GUIDE Plus+ system.
One-Button-Record
The RED Action button (Record) is visible
anytime you can highlight a programme
title, including from the Grid, after a search,
or in your recommendations in the My TV
area.
6 Grid – Shows TV listings information for
the next seven days by channel and time.
GUIDE Plus+ navigation
The table below shows a summary of the
remote buttons you’ll use to navigate the
GUIDE Plus+ system.
The programme name, date, channel,
recording start and end times are all set
automatically when you set a timer
recording using One-Button-Record.
Key
What it does
If you need to, you can edit the settings at
any time before the recording is due to start
(see Editing a scheduled recording on
page 43).
Press to set or cancel One
Button Recording.
ꢀ REC
Press to display the GUIDE
Plus+ screen (also use to
exit).
GUIDE
1
Highlight a programme title.
ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ
Use to navigate screens
(highlight an item).
RED, GREEN,
Action buttons that change
YELLOW, BLUE functionality depending on
the Area.
MENU
Press to jump directly to the
Menu bar.
TIMER REC
INFO
Press to go directly to the
Schedule area.
Press to display extended
information for the current
programme.
2
Press the RED Action button (Record).
The programme is now set for recording.
When the programme is due to start, the
recorder will switch to the correct channel
ENTER
Press to confirm a selection
or to leave the GUIDE
Plus+ screen.
1
and start recording .
Number
buttons
Use for numeric entry.
• You can also use the ꢀREC button to set
the recording.
• You can review the shows you have set to
record in the Schedule Area (see also
The Schedule Area on page 42).
ꢆ PREV/
ꢇ NEXT
Press to select the previous/
next page of information (in
the grid, for example).
ꢈ/ꢉ
Press to select the previous/
next day.
Note
1 Recording times set using the GUIDE Plus+ system do not automatically change to reflect any changes that
may occur in the programme broadcast schedules.
38
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
Lock/Unlock video window
When you enter the GUIDE Plus+ system,
Areas
The GUIDE Plus+® system consists of
seven Areas. All Areas can be accessed from
the Menu bar.
the channel you were watching remains
visible in the video window. The date stamp
above the window lets you know the
channel, date and time.
• Grid – The GUIDE Plus+ system Home
Area. Displays TV listings information for
the next seven days by time and channel.
The default setting for this window is
‘locked’, as indicated by a closed padlock
icon above the video window. When locked,
the video window always shows the channel
you were previously watching as you move
up and down through the listings grid.
• Search – Search for TV programmes by
category (e.g., Sport), subcategory (e.g.,
Football) or keyword.
• My TV – Set up a profile and receive
recommendations according to your
preferences.
If you prefer, you can unlock the video
window so that as you highlight different
channels in the listings grid, that channel is
shown in the video window.
• Schedule – Show all scheduled
recordings.
• Info – Area for additional information,
such as weather (not available in all
regions).
1
Highlight a channel logo.
• Editor – Change channel settings.
• Setup – Setup the GUIDE Plus+®
system.
The Grid Area
The Grid is the main TV listings screen of the
GUIDE Plus+ system and is the first screen
that you see when you press GUIDE. You can
see TV listings for the next seven days,
starting with the current day.
Channel logos are displayed to the left of
programme titles.
2
Press the RED Action button (Unlock).
When you highlight a programme in the
Grid, you can see information about it in the
Information Box, including title, synopsis,
channel, source, time and length. If there is
an i symbol in the Information Box, it means
that there is an extended synopsis available.
Press the INFO button to see it.
The padlock icon above the video window
becomes unlocked. It remains unlocked for
the remainder of your current TV viewing
session.
If you want to lock the video window again,
follow the same procedure. The RED Action
button will now act as Lock.
In some countries, you can also see a rating
for a particular programme (mostly movies).
These ratings are provided by local partners,
such as TV magazines.
Channel mosaic screen
You can switch the display style of channels
in the Grid Area, Schedule Area or My TV
Area from a list to a mosaic of channel icons
by pressing the YELLOW Action button.
Select the channel icon you want using the
cursor buttons, then press ENTER to return
to the previous screen on that channel.
From the Grid Area you can:
• View and scroll through programme
listings
• Read programme synopses
39
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
• Tune to a programme that’s currently
1
showing
1
bar.
Select ‘Search’ from the Menu
• Set a programme to record
• Lock or unlock the video window
• Access Information panels
2
Select a category and a
Browsing the Grid
subcategory.
Use the following remote buttons to browse
the grid:
ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ (cursor buttons) – Navigate the
Grid
ꢆ PREV/ꢇ NEXT – Previous / next page
ꢈ/ꢉ – Previous / next day
BLUE Action button – Return to the current
time/date in the Grid
ENTER – Press on the current selection to
exit the GUIDE Plus+ system and start
watching the programme
• If you choose All as the subcategory, all
programmes in the category you
selected will show up in the search
results.
The Search Area
From the Search Area you can:
• Search by category
• Search by subcategory
• Search by keyword
ENTER
3
Start the search.
The search results are shown sorted by time
and date.
• Read programme synopses
• Tune to a programme that’s currently
showing
• If no search results are displayed, it
means there are no programmes for the
current day that match your search
criteria.
• Set a programme to record
• Access Information panels
Searching
You can search for programmes by category,
subcategory or by keyword (My Choice).
Categories for searching include Movies
(purple), Sport (green), Children (blue) and
Others (teal). In some countries there is a
further subcategory available called ‘Tip of
the Day’. These are programmes
recommended by a local partner, such as a
TV magazine.
Note
1 If you’re using an external tuner (satellite tuner, for example), there will be a short delay of a couple of seconds
while it tunes to the channel. This is normal.
40
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
Using My Choice keywords for a search
In addition to the standard categories, you
can also set your own keywords.
My TV Area
The My TV Area allows you to set up a
personal profile. You can define a profile by
channels, themes and/or keywords. As soon
as a personal profile has been set, the
GUIDE Plus+ system continuously scans
the TV listings for the next seven days.
Whenever you access the My TV Area, a list
of programmes matching your profile
appears.
1
Access My Choice.
From the My TV Area you can:
• Set up a profile by channel, theme and/
or keyword
• Edit and delete profiles
• Read programme synopses
• Tune to a programme that’s currently
showing
• Set a programme to record
• Access Information panels
2
Press the YELLOW Action button to
add a keyword.
Setting up a profile
ENTER
You can set up a profile with any
combination of up to 16 channels, four
categories and 16 keywords.
3
Enter a keyword to appear in
the menu.
1
2
Select ‘My TV’ from the Menu bar.
Press the YELLOW Action button to
set a profile.
When you’re finished, press the GREEN
Action button to exit and continue.
ENTER
4
Start the keyword search.
• You can delete or edit keywords using
the RED and GREEN Action buttons.
Channels is now highlighted.
• When you have set more than two
keywords, an All subcategory
automatically appears which allows you
to search for all your keywords.
41
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
3
To add a channel to your profile,
5
To add a keyword to your profile,
press the YELLOW Action button.
highlight ‘Keywords’ and press the
YELLOW Action button.
Select a channel from the mosaic of channel
icons and press ENTER. Repeat this step to
add up to 16 channels.
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons followed by
ENTER to select characters from the on-
screen keyboard. When you’re finished,
press the GREEN Action button to exit and
continue.
4
To add a category to your profile,
highlight ‘Categories’ and press the
YELLOW Action button.
6
Press ENTER to activate your profile.
• You can add up to 16 keywords by
repeating step 5.
• You can edit or delete your profile using
the RED and GREEN Action buttons.
The Schedule Area
The Schedule Area is where you can set, see,
edit and delete scheduled (timer)
recordings.
From the Schedule Area you can:
• Edit or delete a One-Button-Recording
Select a category from the Search Area
categories and press ENTER. Repeat this
step to add up to four categories.
• Set, edit or delete a VIDEO Plus+
recording
• Set, edit or delete a manual recording
42
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
4
Enter a name for the scheduled
Editing a scheduled recording
You can edit any parameter in a scheduled
recording.
recording, or delete it if you no longer require
1
it .
1
Highlight the left tile of a scheduled
recording.
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons followed by
ENTER to select characters from the on-
screen keyboard.
After entering the whole name, press the
GREEN Action button to continue.
• If you only want to edit the recording
quality, frequency, destination, timing or
genre settings, skip to step 5 below.
5
6
Highlight the right recording tile.
Press the RED Action button (Quality)
to change the recording quality.
2
3
Press the GREEN Action button (Edit).
Use the cursor and number buttons
to edit the recording date, start time, end
time and channel.
2
Select from AUTO , XP, SP, LP, EP, SLP, SEP
or a manual recording mode (see Manual
Recording on page 135 and Manual recording
modes on page 145).
Use the ꢁ/ꢂbuttons or the number buttons
to edit.
Press the GREEN Action button to go to
continue, or the RED Action button to go
back.
Note
1 See About timer recordings on page 68 for more information about scheduled recordings.
2 This mode maximizes the recording quality to fit on to a single DVD disc. Can also be used when recording to
HDD.
43
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
7
Press the GREEN Action button
• Auto Replace Recording is only available
as an option with regular daily or weekly
recordings.
(Frequency) to change the recording
frequency.
9
Press ꢀ to access the extended
recording options.
Select from the various options for one-time,
daily and weekly recordings.
• If you want to record to a particular HDD
genre, use the YELLOW Action button
(Genre) to select one.
8
Press YELLOW Action button
(Destination) to select the recording
destination.
• Use the GREEN Action button (Timing)
to add extra time to the end of the
recording (+0, +10, +20, +30 or VPS/
2
PDC (V–P)).
• Press ꢃ to display the standard
recording options again.
Select from DVD, HDD or HDDr (Auto
1
Replace Recording) .
Note
1 • For a DVD timer recording, if Optimized Rec (see Optimized Rec on page 135) is set to On (and VPS/PDC is
off), the recorder will adjust the recording quality to try and fit the recording on the disc. If the recording will not
fit onto the disc even on MN1 recording quality (MN4 for DVD+R/+RW) then the Recovery Recording feature
will automatically make the recording to the HDD instead.
• If there is very little free space left on the HDD, an Auto Replace Recording may not complete successfully.
• If the HDD is being used for playback or high-speed copying when an Auto Replace Recording is due to start,
the new timer recording will not replace the old one. However, the next time the timer recording starts, both of
the older two programmes will be erased.
2 • If you set the timer recording to use VPS/PDC, you must switch the recorder into standby before the timer
recording is due to start for it to work correctly. For non-VPS/PDC timer recordings there is no need to switch
the recorder into standby.
• Optimized Recording will not work if VPS/PDC is on.
• Up to eight timer recordings can be set with VPS/PDC.
• VPS/PDC cannot be set for recordings made from digital broadcasts or an external input, or when the
recording mode is set to AUTO.
44
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
3
Use the number buttons to enter a
Deleting a scheduled recording
Highlight the left tile of a scheduled
PlusCode programming number.
1
recording.
Please enter the PlusCode programming number and press
ENTER to confirm.
• If you live in an area not yet covered by
the GUIDE Plus+ system you may also
have to input a channel number. Follow
the on-screen display to do this.
2
Press the RED Action button (Delete).
The scheduled event is deleted.
Setting a VIDEO Plus+® recording
4
Press ENTER to confirm.
1
Select ‘Schedule’ from the Menu
bar.
Setting a manual recording
1 Select ‘Schedule’ from the Menu bar.
2
Press the RED Action button (VIDEO
Plus+).
2
Press the GREEN Action button
(Manual).
45
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
3
Use the number and ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ
The Info Area
buttons to enter the recording date, then
press the GREEN Action button (Next).
This area is reserved for additional
information such as news, weather reports,
stock quotes, and so on, and varies by
region. (Note that this feature is not available
in all countries/regions.)
The Editor Area
The Editor Area is the central location for you
to manage your channels. Any changes you
make here will affect what is displayed in the
Grid Area. The Editor Area is mainly used
when setting up the GUIDE Plus+ system to
make any manual changes as necessary.
You can also use the Editor Area if new
channels become available in your area, or if
you change from cable to satellite, say, or
move house.
4
In the same way, enter the recording
start time, followed by the GREEN Action
button (Next) to confirm.
From the Editor Area you can:
5
Enter the recording end time in the
same way, followed by the GREEN Action
button (Next) to confirm.
• Display/hide channels in the grid (switch
the channel on/off)
6
Use the number buttons to enter a
• Select a channel source (A.TV, D.TV,
Ext. Rec. 1, Ext. Rec. 2, etc.)
channel number, then press the GREEN
Action button (Next) to confirm.
• Enter a channel programme number
Switching a channel on/off
You can choose whether or not to display a
channel in the Grid Area by switching the
channel on or off in the Editor Area.
D.TV 001
1
Select ‘Editor’ from the Menu bar.
Name
BBC1
BBC2
ITV
CH4
CH5
BBC3
ITV2
E4
On/Off Source
Prog. No.
001
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
Off
On
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
Ext. Rec. 1
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
Alternatively, you can press the YELLOW
Action button (Mosaic) and use the ꢁ/ꢂ/
ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select a channel from the
mosaic, followed by ENTER.
002
003
004
005
007
006
014
017
UKGOL
2
channel you want to switch on or off.
Press the RED Action button to switch
the channel on or off.
Highlight the left channel tile of the
3
46
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
Changing the source and programme
number
The Setup Area
The Setup Area is where you can set up the
GUIDE Plus+ system for your particular
region, TV reception conditions, and so on.
1
Select ‘Editor’ from the Menu bar.
Making changes to your GUIDE Plus+
setup
1
Select ‘Setup’ from the Menu bar.
Prog. No.
001
002
003
004
005
007
006
014
017
Name
BBC1
BBC2
ITV
CH4
CH5
BBC3
ITV2
E4
On/Off Source
On
On
On
On
On
On
On
Off
On
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
Ext. Rec. 1
D. TV
D. TV
D. TV
Press ENTER to access the Basic Setup screen.
UKGOL
Basic Setup
Host Channel Setup
GUIDE Plus+ System Information
2
channel you want to make a change to.
Press the RED Action button to
Highlight the right channel tile of the
3
change the channel source, or the GREEN
Action button to enter a programme
number.
2
Highlight the part you want to
Each press of the RED Action button
changes the channel source (A.TV, D.TV,
Ext. Rec. 1, etc.). To set a programme
number, use the number buttons to enter a
programme number then press ENTER
(When set to A.TV or D.TV, make sure that
the programme number matches the preset
number of this recorder for what you want to
record).
change.
You can change the Language, Country,
1
Postal Code and the External Receiver
settings.
3
Press ENTER to confirm.
Note
1 Making changes to the Country or Postal Code settings may require a new download of TV listings information.
This can take up to 24 hours.
47
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
Manual Host Channel setup
GUIDE Plus+ FAQ and
The GUIDE Plus+ system will automatically
troubleshooting
identify your Host Channel as soon as the
recorder is put into standby for the first time.
See the table on page 35 for a list of all the
European Host Channels.
This FAQ covers only a few questions. For a
complete list please consult the GUIDE
Plus+ website at:
www.europe.guideplus.com
If you know your Host Channel details
(source and programme number) or if the
automatic identification did not provide the
expected result, you can identify your Host
Channel manually. Select Host Channel
Setup in the Setup area and follow the
instructions on the TV. Select the correct
source (e.g., internal tuner or external
receiver) and enter the respective
FAQ
• When I tried setting up my external
receiver I could not get any of the
attempts to work, what should I do?
There could be several reasons why your
external receiver could not be controlled.
programme number (e.g., if you have to
press 9 on the remote to watch your Host
Channel, enter 9 as the programme
number). When you next switch the recorder
into standby the GUIDE Plus+ system will
complete the Host Channel setup.
– The connections could be wrong. Make
sure that the G-LINK cable is connected
to the G-LINK connector on the recorder
and the IR blaster is in front of the
external receiver, pointing towards the
IR receiver of your external receiver. See
Connecting to a cable box or satellite
receiver on page 17.
You can reset the Host Channel settings at
any time back to the default setting of
automatic. Please be aware that resetting
the Host Channel will erase all TV listings
data.
– The code that is listed under your
brand could be wrong. Please try other
codes for your brand under satellite,
cable or terrestrial. Go to the Setup Area
and choose one of the three options
(cable, satellite or terrestrial) that you
have not already tried. Follow the on-
screen prompts to make sure that the
GUIDE Plus+ system can change
channels on your external receiver. If it
does not work, repeat the process,
choosing different reception and
external receiver combinations until you
have tried all the codes for your brand of
receiver that are already in the GUIDE
Plus+ system. If it still does not work,
see below on how to receive new codes
overnight.
– The unit has not yet received new
codes. The nightly data downloads
frequently include new codes for
controlling external receivers. Please
tune your external receiver to your local
host channel and leave it on overnight.
48
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
Switch this recorder into standby. The
next morning, please perform the GUIDE
Plus+ setup again to see if your external
receiver can now be controlled.
terrestrial or cable connection only to
receive data this way. It is important that
you identify your host channel correctly
in the Editor Area.
– The external receiver that you use is
currently not supported. If, after leaving
your external receiver on overnight, and
doing the Reception and External
• After I performed the initial set-up I found
that the line-up for all the channels
received via the external set top box is
incorrect. How do I correct this?
Receiver Setup again, it still does not
respond, please call Customer Support
to report your brand and model.
You can change the line-up in the editor
according to your preferences. Access
the Editor Area. Select the channels that
you would like to change. Change the
source and preset number according to
your preferences.
• My external receiver was successfully
setup. However I have found that when
the GUIDE Plus+ system has to change
to a channel with a three-digit programme
number in the external receiver’s preset, it
does not work. It looks like the GUIDE
Plus+ system can only send two digits.
• I performed the set-up but after many
hours I still have a blank EPG what is
going wrong?
There are several possibilities:
With the number of channels
– Connections are wrong. See
Connections on page 14 to double check
everything.
increasing, the number of digits has
increased as well. While older boxes use
only two digits, newer boxes require up
to four. It is possible that you selected an
older code for your brand during set-up.
Please access the Setup Area, select
External Receiver and repeat the setup
for your brand (Note: Every time you see
the on-screen question about whether
the receiver has changed to a certain
channel, the GUIDE Plus+ system has
sent a different code). Try all the different
codes until your GUIDE Plus+ system
can control your external receiver
– The initial setup of GUIDE Plus+ was
completed incorrectly. Try setting it up
again (see Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®
system on page 33).
– Your cabling and setup is OK, but the
recorder has not been connected for
enough time to receive the TV listings
data. Leave the recorder in standby
overnight.
– For external receiver users only: The
connections and setup are OK, but the
external receiver was not tuned to the
correct host channel. Check the list of
host channels (see step 5 of Setting up
the GUIDE Plus+® system on page 33)
and leave the recorder in standby and
the external receiver on overnight tuned
to the correct host channel.
correctly. If you have no success, try to
receive new codes overnight.
• I used to receive data through my
terrestrial antenna or analog cable
without a set-top box. Now, I have
“upgraded” to a satellite system or to
digital cable with external receiver. What
should I do to receive data for the GUIDE
Plus+ system?
– You live in a country/region where the
GUIDE Plus+ system is not yet available.
Check the list of countries to see if you
are in a region that is supported.
You can try to receive your host channel
through your new reception method. If
you have problems to receive data we
recommend that you keep your analog
49
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide
05
• I used the One-Button-Record feature (red
Action button) to set a recording, but I
recorded the wrong channel.
• The automatic Host Channel search
failed or the GUIDE Plus+ system
identified the wrong Host Channel for my
region.
If the channel to be recorded is received
via the external receiver first make sure
that the external receiver was left
switched on. Next, in the Editor Area,
make sure that the channel to be
You can identify your Host Channel
manually. See Manual Host Channel
setup on page 48 for how to do this.
recorded is correctly set: Access the
Editor Area. Check the source and
programme number of the channel that
you wanted to record. Change the
source and preset numbers if incorrect.
If you are recording from the recorder’s
internal tuner (the A.TV or D.TV
setting), make sure that the programme
number is the same as the preset
number set on this recorder. If they are
different, go to the Editor Area and
change the programme number to
match the recorder’s preset number.
• The TV listings information doesn’t
update.
The latest TV listings information is
automatically downloaded by the
recorder overnight. This only happens if
the recorder is in standby; if the recorder
is left on, it will not download. When not
using the recorder, please switch it into
standby.
Data downloads can take several hours.
The front panel display shows EPG when
downloading. If you switch the recorder
on while EPG is displayed, the download
will be cancelled.
• The GUIDE Plus+ system is not
supported in my area, but when I switch
the recorder into standby, after a while the
front panel display shows EPG. Can I stop
this from happening?
If the GUIDE Plus+ system is not
supported in your area, please do not set
the postal code in the GUIDE Plus+
setup (see Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®
system on page 33). When the GUIDE
Plus+ service starts in your area, please
set the postal code again.
50
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
Chapter 6
Using the digital electronic
programme guide
5
Indicates the programme set for
This chapter is only applicable if the EPG Type
Select setting made in the Setup Navigator (or
the Initial Setup menu) is set to Digital EPG.
recording
6
Appears when other programmes (often
short ones) have been scheduled for the
same period
7
8
The Digital EPG system
Programme title
Time dividers
The Digital EPG shows a table of scheduled
digital TV programmes and detailed
information about individual programmes. It
also allows you easily to select and tune to a
particular programme.
• The general programme list may show
sections whose bottom right corners
have been folded. This indicates that
other programmes have been scheduled
for that period. To view the title of such a
programme and related information,
highlight a folded section, and then
press ꢃ/ꢀ.
1
The Digital EPG screen consists of
programme Information, Channel List and
General Programme List. This section
describes information displayed in the
schedule and information windows.
Note that the recorder’s clock must be set to
the correct time and date to ensure all
relevant EPG information is displayed.
Programme information
D007
General Programme List
D007
1
2
3
4
Channel number
Station name
Programme title
Appear when other programmes have
been scheduled for the same period
5
6
Programme schedule
Programme genre
1
Appears when the schedule table can be
scrolled forward or backward
2
3
4
Time schedule
Channel list
Highlights the currently selected
channel
Note
51
En
1 EPG information is only viewable for D.TV programmes that provide EPG information.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
• To quit the display of detailed
information, press INFO again (or
Using the Digital EPG
Using the Digital EPG you can check the
schedule of digital TV programmes, view
information about desired programmes,
and/or select programmes.
RETURN/EXIT).
D007
13:40 -14:05
************
*************
**************************
GUIDE
1
Press to display the Digital EPG
screen.
The EPG screen updates automatically if the
EPG data is acquired successfully. If not, the
Digital EPG screen shows a blank image.
More...
GUIDE
4
Press to exit the Digital EPG
screen.
2
Select a TV programme.
Setting timer programmes
D007
Using the Digital EPG, it’s easy to set digital
2
TV programmes for recording .
GUIDE
1
Press to display the Digital EPG
Select a programme.
screen.
ENTER
• Press ꢆ PREV/ꢇ NEXT to skip to
the next or previous channel list page.
2
• Information about the selected
D007
programme appears in the information
1
window.
• To watch a programme currently on air,
select the programme (then press
ENTER).
• You can check information about
programmes scheduled up to one week
ahead, depending on conditions.
• Select a programme currently on-air:
press ENTER to close the Digital EPG
screen and watch the channel
immediately, or press RED to set the
programme for recording immediately.
• Depending on conditions, it may take
some time to acquire EPG data.
INFO
3
Press to view more information
• Select a programme not yet started then
press ENTER or RED to set the
programme for recording.
about the selected programme.
Detailed information appears in the
schedule window.
If the screen contains further information,
More ... is displayed.
Note
1 The general programme list does not show programmes that have already finished.
2 For more information on timer programmes, see About timer recordings on page 68.
52
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
3
Enter the timer recording settings.
4
If you want to change the recording
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select a field; use
the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to change the value .
mode, recording destination, etc., select
‘Set Detailed’.
In this area you can set:
1
Record to – Select HDD for hard disk
recording or DVD for DVD recording .
Timer Programme Set
Manhattan Open Tennis
2
CH
Date
SUN 1/4
Start
18:00
Stop
19:00
Extend
Off
3
D.TV003
Recording Mode – Select from AUTO , XP,
Store Programme
SP, LP, EP, SLP, SEP (See Setting the picture
quality/recording time on page 64). If Manual
Recording is on, then you can also select the
LPCM setting, XP+ or MN (press ENTER
then use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select the
level).
Detailed Settings
Record To
Recording Mode
VPS/PDC
Auto Replace Rec.
Genre
Enter Details
HDD
XP
------
------
Set Detailed
Set Title Name
Cancel
No Category
VPS/PDC 0/8
4
• CH – Choose a channel (Pr 1 to Pr 99 for
analog channels and available digital
channels (excluding skip channels)), or
one of the external inputs from which to
record.
VPS/PDC – Choose whether or not to use
VPS/PDC when making timer recordings of
analog programmes (see About timer
recordings on page 68).
Auto Replace Rec. – Automatically erases
the previous daily or weekly recording when
the next one is recorded.
• Date – Choose a date up to one month in
advance, or select a daily or weekly
programme.
Genre – Select a record genre (for HDD
recording only).
• Start – Set the recording start time.
• Stop – Set the recording end time
(maximum length of a timer recording is
24 hours).
• Extend – Extend the end time of the
timer recording (select Off, 10, 20 or 30
mins.)
Note
1 You cannot change the CH, Date, Start, Stop, Extend and title name when you have EPG Link set to On (see
page 54).
2 • For a DVD timer recording, if Optimized Rec (see Optimized Rec on page 135) is set to On (and VPS/PDC is
off), the recorder will adjust the recording quality to try and fit the recording on the disc. If the recording will not
fit onto the disc even on MN1 recording quality (MN4 for DVD+R/+RW) then the Recovery Recording feature
will automatically make the recording to the HDD instead.
• If there is very little free space left on the HDD, an Auto Replace Recording may not complete successfully.
• If the HDD is being used for playback or high-speed copying when an Auto Replace Recording is due to start,
the new timer recording will not replace the old one. However, the next time the timer recording starts, both of
the older two programmes will be erased.
3 This mode maximizes the recording quality to fit on to a single DVD disc. Can also be used when recording to
HDD.
4 • If you set the timer recording to use VPS/PDC, you must switch the recorder into standby before the timer
recording is due to start for it to work correctly. For non-VPS/PDC timer recordings there is no need to switch
the recorder into standby.
• Optimized Recording will not work if VPS/PDC is on.
• Up to eight timer recordings can be set with VPS/PDC.
• VPS/PDC cannot be set for recordings made from digital broadcasts or an external input, or when the
recording mode is set to AUTO.
53
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
1
This screen shows all the timer programmes
currently set.
EPG Link (UK only) – Choose whether or not
to have this device automatically record
scheduled programmes from the Digital
EPG even if the times in which they are
broadcast change.
Timer Programme View
SUN 25/3 15:00
VPS/PDC 0/8
Manhattan Open Tennis
Tmr Pgms 3/32
OK
SUN 25/3 18:00
World Journey
MON 26/3 19:30
–
19:00
21:00
14:00
Pr
Pr
Pr
4
6
8
OK
2
Series Recording (UK only) – Choose
–
Flower
Until 20/4
whether or not to record all programmes
from a series when you make a recording
from the Digital EPG (for HDD recordings
only).
MON
–
FRI 13:30
–
New Input
HDD Remain
DVD Remain
59h59m(SP)
1h59m(SP)
5
After entering all the timer recording
information, highlight ‘Store
Programme’ and press ENTER.
A red clock icon appears for the programme.
• Each row is for one timer recording
programme, with the date and time
information, channel, recording mode,
DVD or HDD and recording status.
GUIDE
6
Press to exit the Digital EPG
• The amount of free space available on
the HDD and the currently loaded
recordable DVD is shown towards the
bottom of the screen.
screen.
Tip
• In the upper-right corner, the number of
timer programmes already set is shown
next to Tmr Pgms.
• To enter a title name for the timer
recording in advance, select Set Title
Name and follow the on-screen display.
• If there are more than five timer
programmes already set, press
ꢇNEXT to switch page (go back using
the ꢆ PREV button).
Editing a timer programme
You can change any of the settings in a timer
programme before the recording is due to
start. Even if a programme is currently being
recorded, you can program a new end time
or edit its extend time parameter.
• You can also delete a timer programme
before it’s started (before the recorder
enters timer recording standby) by
highlighting it and pressing CLEAR. See
also Deleting a timer programme on
page 56.
TIMER
REC
1
Press to display the Timer
Programme View screen.
You can also access the Timer Programme
View screen from the Home Menu (press
HOME MENU, select Timer Recording,
then Timer Recording).
Note
1 • You cannot set an EPG Link when recording mode is set to AUTO.
• You cannot change the CH, Date, Start, Stop, Extend and title name when you have EPG Link set to On.
• When you have EPG Link set to On and you set a timer recording for a programme that is divided into multiple
parts, all parts of that programme are recorded automatically. In the programme list, the earliest part of the
programme to be recorded has a red
by the broadcaster determines which programmes are classified as divided programmes.
2 • In the programme list, the earliest programme to be recorded has a red icon, with successive programmes
indicated by a gray icon.
icon, with successive parts indicated by a gray
icon. Data provided
• There is a limit to the number of programmes you can schedule to record with the Series Recording function.
• Data provided by the broadcaster determines which programmes are classified as part of a series.
54
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
• Cancel Once – A regular timer
programme is set to skip.
2
Highlight the timer
• Can’t Rec – Not possible to record.
programme you want to change
If you want to set a new timer programme,
select ‘New Input’ and skip to step 4.
.
• Title Over – Can’t record because there
is already the maximum number of titles
on the disc (HDD: 999; DVD: 99).
• Recording – The programme is currently
ENTER
recording.
3
Press ꢀ then select ‘Modify’
• Standby – The recorder is in timer
recording standby.
from the command menu panel.
Alternatively, press ENTER.
• Valid Until ... (eg., Valid Until 13/8) (UK
only) – When you have set to make a
series recording of a programme that
has no new scheduled broadcasts, the
date displayed indicates the last day
until which the scheduled programme
settings remain valid. (If the programme
is not broadcast for over 13 weeks, its
settings are automatically deleted.)
The Timer Programme Set screen appears
from which you can edit the settings.
ENTER
4
Enter the timer recording
settings.
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select a field; use
the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to change the value. For
more information on the options available at
the Timer Programme Set screen, See
Setting timer programmes on page 52.
• No Broadcast (UK only) – Displays when
a programme for which you had the EPG
Link set to On does not record because
the date of the scheduled recording has
already passed.
ENTER
5
After entering all the timer
• nothing displayed – Another timer
recording or copying is in progress.
recording information, highlight ‘Store
Programme’ and press ENTER.
The timer recording list screen is displayed
again. The timer programme you just input
appears in the list. The rightmost column
shows various timer recording status
messages:
HOME MENU
6
Press to exit the timer
recording screen.
Note
• If you set a DVD timer recording but
there is no recordable DVD disc loaded,
or the disc loaded doesn’t have enough
free space for the complete recording,
Recovery is shown. In this case (unless
you load a suitable disc before the
recording actually starts), the recorder
will use the HDD for recording. (The
message Can’t Rec will appear if there
are already 999 titles on the HDD or if
there is not enough free space on the
HDD for recording.)
• OK – Can be recorded.
• Time Over – Not enough space on the
HDD (the recording won’t finish).
• Over 12h – Recording time of over 12
hours set (when recording to the HDD
the recording will be split into two titles).
• Overlap – Two timer programmes
partially or completely overlap. The one
starting earlier will take priority.
• Until ... (eg., Until 13/8) – For a regular
recording, the last programme that
could be recorded is shown.
• Data Over – Can’t record because the
disc management area of the disc is full.
55
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
• When you have EPG Link or Series
Recording set to On, any changes in
ENTER
broadcast time or division of broadcasts
are automatically accommodated for
and your scheduled recordings are
carried out without any additional
settings. As a result, even when you have
not scheduled programmes to record at
the same time, changes in broadcasting
schedules can cause scheduled
3
Press ꢀ then select ‘Cancel
Once’ from the command menu panel.
• In the timer programme list, Cancel
Once appears by the programme.
• You can also just press ꢅ PAUSE when
the timer programme is highlighted.
Checking for alternative broadcast
times
(UK only)
recordings to overlap.
Deleting a timer programme
You can delete timer programmes you no
longer need.
You can check to see if a programme you
have scheduled to record is airing at an
alternative time slot .
1
TIMER
REC
TIMER
REC
1
Press TIMER REC.
1
Press TIMER REC.
2
Highlight the timer
2
Highlight the timer
programme you want to erase
.
programme you want to search.
ENTER
ENTER
3
Press ꢀ then select ‘Erase’
3
Press ꢀthen select ‘Alternate
from the command menu panel.
Search’ from the command menu panel.
• The search results are displayed.
Choose the programme you would like to
record and press either the RED button
or ENTER to schedule a recording.
• Select Yes to confirm or No to cancel.
• You can also just press CLEAR when the
timer programme is highlighted.
Skipping a regular timer
programme
If you’ve set a regular daily or weekly timer
programme, you can set the recorder to skip
the next scheduled recording.
Searching for series
(UK only)
You can search for broadcasts of
programmes of the same series as a
1
programme you have scheduled to record .
TIMER
REC
TIMER
REC
1
Press TIMER REC.
1
Press TIMER REC.
2
Highlight the timer
2
Highlight the timer
programme you want to skip
.
programme you want to search.
Note
1 • Programme search results are based upon data provided by the broadcaster.
• This function may not be applicable to all programmes.
56
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
Other useful EPG functions
06
ENTER
3
Press ꢀ then select ‘Series
Search’ from the command menu panel.
• The search results are displayed.
Choose the programme you would like to
record and press either the RED button
or ENTER to schedule a recording.
EPG Jump
1
Press GREEN when the Digital EPG
screen (Programme List, Detailed
information or Search Result) is
displayed.
Searching for recommendations
(UK only)
2
In the ‘Date’ field select a date
You can search for recommended
(within one week) to jump to.
programmes generated from the content of
the programmes you have scheduled to
Date
Time
Mon.13.Sep
14:00
1
record .
Jump
Cancel
TIMER
REC
1
Press TIMER REC.
3
In the ‘Time’ field select a time
of the day (0:00 to 23:00) to jump to.
2
Highlight the timer
programme you want to search.
ENTER
4
Select ‘Jump’.
ENTER
The Programme List for the specified day
and time is displayed.
3
Press ꢀ then select
‘Recommendation Search’ from the
command menu panel.
The search results are displayed. Choose the
programme you would like to record and
press either the RED button or ENTER to
schedule a recording.
EPG Search
1
Press YELLOW when the EPG screen
(Programme List, Detailed information or
Search Result) is displayed.
2
In the ‘Date’ field select a date
(within one week) to search in.
Date
Sun.12.Sep
12:00
Time
Genre
Select
0/16
•
•
•
•
•
•
Search
Cancel
Note
1 • Programme search results are based upon data provided by the broadcaster.
• This function may not be applicable to all programmes.
57
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the digital electronic programme guide
06
3
In the ‘Time’ field select the
time of day (0:00 to 23:00) to search in.
4
In the ‘Genre’ field, select the
genre to search for.
You can search for multiple genres by
pressing ENTER after each genre.
ENTER
5
6
Select ‘OK’.
ENTER
Select ‘Search’.
The results of your search are displayed.
58
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
Chapter 7
Recording
About DVD recording
Max.
chapters
(per title)
Disc type/rec.
format
Max. titles
(per disc)
This recorder can record to DVD-R, DVD-
RW, DVD+R, DVD+RW, DVD-RAM, DVD-R
DL and DVD+R DL media.
DVD-R/-RW
Video mode
99
99
49
99
DVD-R and DVD-RW discs can be initialized
for Video mode or VR mode recording. Each
has its advantages, and it depends on what
you want to do with the recording which
mode you choose.
*1
DVD-R/-RW/-RAM
VR mode
999
*2
DVD+R/+RW
99
If you want to edit your recordings in any
significant way, VR mode offers greater
possibilities for cutting, copying, and
changing the way the video is presented.
*1 A maximum of 999 chapters are recordable per disc.
*2
A maximum of 254 chapters are recordable per disc.
• This recorder cannot play or record
unfinalized DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)
and DVD+R discs recorded on another
recorder. DVD+RW discs recorded on
another recorder are playable on this
recorder but are not recordable.
Video mode is less flexible when it comes to
editing, but it has the advantage that it is
compatible with standard DVD players
1
(many of which won’t play VR mode discs ).
Once a disc is initialized for a particular
mode, all recording on that disc will be in
that mode.
• The maximum continuous recording
time for one title is eight hours when
using a DVD+R/+RW disc.
DVD+RW discs can be initialized for +VR
mode recording.
• If you delete a title from a DVD+R/+RW
disc, the total number of recordable
titles remaining may not increase.
DVD-RAM discs can be initialized for VR
mode recording.
• Although this recorder can record PAL,
SECAM, NTSC and PAL-60, you can’t mix
multiple TV line systems on one disc. A
disc can contain PAL and SECAM
recordings, or NTSC and PAL-60. See
also Additional information about the TV
system settings on page 141.
DVD+R discs do not require initializing.
Important
• The table below shows the maximum
number of titles recordable per disc and
the maximum number of chapters per
title:
• Fingerprints, dirt and small scratches on
a disc can affect playback and/or
recording performance. Please take
proper care of your discs.
• Pioneer takes no responsibility for
recording failure due to power cuts,
defective discs, or damage to the
recorder.
Note
1 Some DVD players, such as some Pioneer models, are compatible with VR mode discs. Check the operating
instructions for your player for VR mode compatibility information.
59
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
• See also Disc/content format playback
compatibility on page 7 for detailed disc
compatibility information.
• It is possible to record both PAL and
NTSC titles on the HDD. Before
recording, you need to make sure that
the Input Line System setting (page 141)
matches the TV line system of the source
you’re recording.
Recording to DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL
discs
Recording to DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL discs is
generally the same as recording to regular
single-layer discs; however, please note the
following points:
HDD Video mode compatibility
When recording to the HDD you can choose
to record in one of two formats. Set the
format from the HDD Recording Format
item in the Initial Setup menu (see
page 136).
• When the recorder switches from the
first layer to the second during recording
a DVD-R DL (Video mode) disc, a new
title is automatically started on the new
layer.
When set to Video Mode On, high-speed
copying from HDD to DVD-R/-RW (Video
mode) or DVD+R/+RW is possible. When
recording a bilingual broadcast, set which
channel you want to record from the Initial
Setup menu (see Bilingual Recording on
page 132).
• Up to 99 titles can be recorded on a
DVD-R DL (Video mode) disc. If the 99th
title is being recorded when the layer is
switched, recording will stop.
• Up to 49 titles can be recorded on a
DVD+R DL disc.
When HDD Recording Format is set to Video
Mode Off, high-speed copying from HDD to
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW
isn’t possible. However, both channels of
bilingual broadcasts are recorded and you
can switch the audio on playback.
• You cannot play, record additional
material to, edit or finalize a DVD-R DL or
DVD+R DL disc that has been recorded
on but not yet finalized on another DVD
recorder.
Recorded audio
About HDD recording
In all except the LPCM mode, sound is
recorded in two channel Dolby Digital format
(only Dolby Digital 2.0 can be recorded; Dolby
Digital 5.1 recording is not possible). When
set to LPCM, sound is recorded in high
quality, uncompressed Linear PCM format.
Recording to the hard disk drive (HDD) is
very flexible; you have the full choice of
recording quality options, including manual
mode, and of course you can record, erase
and re-record as many times as you like.
The capacity of the hard disk drive means
that you can store many hours of video on it,
even using the higher quality recording
modes.
If the broadcast audio is bilingual and you
are recording to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode),
DVD+R/+RW, or to the HDD with the HDD
Recording Format set to Video Mode On, or
on the LPCM setting, use the Bilingual
Recording setting (page 132) to select the
A/L or B/R audio channel to record before
recording starts. In other cases, both
Important
• The maximum number of titles/chapters
per title that can be recorded on the
HDD is 999 and 99 respectively. No more
recording is possible on the HDD after
the maximum number of titles has been
reached.
channels of a bilingual broadcast will be
recorded and you can switch on playback.
• The maximum continuous recording
time for one title is 12 hours.
60
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
Copying of copyrighted material such as
films or music is unlawful unless permitted
by a legal exception or consented to by the
rightowners.
This product incorporates copyright protection
technology that is protected by method claims of
certain U.S. patents and other intellectual property
rights owned by Macrovision Corporation and other
rights owners. Use of this copyright protection
technology must be authorized by Macrovision
Corporation, and is intended for home and other limited
viewing uses only unless otherwise authorized by
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse engineering or
disassembly is prohibited.
Restrictions on video
recording
You cannot record copy-protected video
using this recorder. Copy-protected video
includes DVD-Video discs and some satellite
broadcasts. If copy-protected material is
encountered during a recording, recording
will pause automatically and an error
message will be displayed on-screen.
Video that is ‘copy-once only’ can only be
recorded to DVD-RAM or HDD, CPRM-
compatible VR mode DVD-R/-RW (see
below).
Using the built-in A.TV and
D.TV tuners
When recording a TV broadcast or through
an external input, you can display copy
control information on screen (see
Displaying disc information on-screen on
page 84).
Switching between A.TV and D.TV
tuners
CPRM
A.TV/D.TV
•
Press to switch between D.TV
CPRM is a copy protection/scrambling
system developed for the recording of ‘copy
once’ broadcast programmes. CPRM stands
for Content Protection for Recordable Media.
(digital) and A.TV (analog).
Changing channels
There are a number of ways to select analog
and digital TV channels. Note that you can’t
This recorder is CPRM compatible, which
means that you can record copy-once
1
broadcast programmes, but you cannot then
make a copy of those recordings. CPRM
recordings can only be made on CPRM-
compatible DVD-R (ver. 2.0/8x or higher) or
DVD-RW (ver. 1.1 or higher) discs formatted
in VR mode, DVD-RAM discs or on the HDD.
change the TV channel during playback,
recording or during recording standby.
CHANNEL
+
–
CHANNEL
•
•
Smart Jog
DVD CPRM recordings can only be played
on players that are specifically compatible
with CPRM.
Number buttons
For example, to select channel 4 (digital
channel D004), press 4 then ENTER; for
channel 34 (digital channel D034), press
Recording equipment and
copyright
Recording equipment should be used only
for lawful copying. You are advised to check
carefully what constitutes lawful copying in
the country in which you are making a copy.
2
3, 4, ENTER.
• CH +/– buttons on the front panel.
• For D.TV channels only, you can also use
the Channel List — see below.
Note
1 • If you select a locked channel, you will need to enter your password to access it.
• While listening to D.TV radio channels, the screen saver automatically starts after no button has been pressed
for three minutes.
61
En
2 Analog channel presets are numbered 1 to 99; digital channel presets are numbered D001 to D999.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
• The channel banner displays the Subtitles
) and Teletext/MHEG ( ) icon if they
Tip
(
• When changing terrestrial digital
broadcast channels, channels with a low
signal strength may result in a black
screen being displayed.
apply to the selected channel.2
• To see more detailed channel
information, press INFO again.
3
Now
11:30-12:00
************************
• For other channels, it may take a short
while for the channel picture to appear,
and/or for the channel number to appear.
More...
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to display
• In both of the above cases, some
improvement may be possible by
adjusting the antenna.
information about previous and following
programmes. Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to
see information about other channels.
Using the D.TV Channel List
• If there is still more information to be
displayed, More ... is displayed; press
the BLUE button to see the extra
information.
When in D.TV mode, you can call up the on-
screen Channel List anytime by pressing ENTER
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to select a channel, then
press ENTER to switch to that channel.1
.
• To hide the channel banner, press
RETURN/EXIT.
D001
D002
D003
D004
D005
D006
************
************
******
Changing D.TV audio languages
************
****
AUDIO
•
Press to display the current audio
******
language. Press repeatedly to change it
to other available languages.
Displaying a channel banner
A channel banner shows programme titles,
start and end times of the current
Changing D.TV subtitle languages
programme and other channel information.
The information is updated every minute.
SUBTITLE
•
Press to display the current
subtitle language. Press repeatedly to
change it to other available languages.
INFO
•
Press to display the channel
banner for the current channel.
Using the MHEG application
(UK only)
D001
Wed.30.Apr 12:46
************
Now
Next
11:30-12:00
12:00 - 12:30
********************
*************
Some stations bring you programmes with
the MHEG (Multimedia and Hypermedia
Expert Group) application encoded, letting
• Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to display the
channel banner for other channels. To
switch to the displayed banner’s
channel, press ENTER.
4
you experience D.TV interactively.
Note
1 • If you select a locked channel, you will need to enter your password to access it.
• While listening to D.TV radio channels, the screen saver automatically starts after no button has been pressed
for three minutes.
2 Due to inaccurate information provided by the broadcaster, some icons may occasionally be present or absent
in error.
3 Not all channels supply more detailed information.
4 If you start recording while the MHEG application is running, the MHEG application screen will also be
recorded. To avoid this, quit the application first, then start recording. It is not possible to start the MHEG
application while recording is in progress.
62
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
• You can also select the language for a
non-NICAM bilingual broadcast.
The channel banner displays an icon ( ) to
indicate that the MHEG application can be
run.
A (L)
B (R)
TEXT
A + B (L+R)
•
Press to start the MHEG
• When watching a recording made from
an external input with Bilingual
recording selected (see External Audio
on page 132), you can switch the audio
channel between left (L), right (R) or both
(L+R).
1
application.
• You can also use any of the colour
buttons.
• Press TEXT to quit the MHEG
application.
L
R
Viewing Teletext
(European countries except the UK.)
L+R
You can view the Teletext that comes
simultaneously with certain programmes.
Note
• When recording to the HDD with HDD
Recording Format set to Video Mode On,
to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode), to DVD+R/
+RW, or on the LPCM setting, only one
channel of a bilingual broadcast is
recorded. In this case, decide which
language you want to record before
recording by setting the Bilingual
Recording setting (see Bilingual
TEXT
•
Press to display the Teletext.
• You can also use any of the colour
buttons.
• Press the TEXT button again to hide the
Teletext screen.
Changing A.TV audio channels
You can change the audio channel of the
broadcast or external input signal.
Recording on page 132).
Switching between TV and DVD
When the recorder is stopped or recording
you can choose whether to have the audio/
video from the built-in TV tuner (or external
input) play on your TV (‘DVD mode’), or
watch the channel that the TV is currently set
to (‘TV mode’).
AUDIO
•
Press to change the audio type.
The current audio channel is displayed on-
screen.
• If the NICAM audio setting (see NICAM
Select on page 132) is set to NICAM and
you are watching a NICAM broadcast,
you can switch between NICAM and
Regular (non-NICAM) audio.
During playback or when a menu is being
displayed on-screen, the sound and video is
always routed to your TV and is unaffected by
the TV/DVD mode setting.
NICAM
Regular
Note that the recorder must be connected to
your TV using a SCART cable to be able to
use this feature.
• If the NICAM broadcast is bilingual, you
can also select the language.
NICAM A
Regular
NICAM B
TV/DVD
NICAM A+B
•
Switch between TV mode and
DVD mode.
Note
63
En
1 This function is not available when subtitle display is active.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
• SLP (Super Long Play) – Lower quality
than EP, but gives about eight hours of
recording time on a DVD disc.
Setting the picture quality/
recording time
• SEP (Super Extended Play) – Lowest
video quality but gives about ten hours of
recording time on a DVD disc.
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
Before starting a recording, you will usually
want to set the picture quality/recording
time. There are six standard settings
available, which allow you to choose a
balance between picture quality and
recording time.
1
2
• MN1 to MN32/LPCM /XP+ – Manual/
Linear PCM/XP+ (available only when
manual recording is on).
The setting is indicated in the front panel
display, and shown on-screen together with
the recording time for a blank recordable
disc. If a recordable disc is loaded, the
approximate remaining recording time for
that disc is also shown. (Note that if the On
Screen Display setting (see On Screen
Display on page 139) is Off then this
information is not displayed.)
When Manual Recording is set to On (see
Manual Recording on page 135), a further
option will be available (MN1 to MN32,
LPCM, or XP+ (a super-high quality HDD
recording mode that features a transfer rate
of around 15 Mbps) depending on what you
set).
When recording to DVD, MN32 is the
highest recording quality available. If you
select XP+, the recording mode will
automatically revert to MN32.
Basic recording from the TV
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
When recording to DVD+R/+RW, SLP is the
longest recording time available. If you
select SEP or MN1 to MN3, the recording
mode will automatically revert to SLP.
Basic recording from the TV involves just
setting the channel to record, choosing
whether to record to the HDD or a DVD and
selecting the recording quality.
REC MODE
HDD/DVD
•
Press repeatedly to select the
recording quality.
1
Select the HDD or DVD for
• XP – High quality setting, gives about
one hour of recording time on a DVD
disc.
recording.
• If you’re recording to DVD, load a
recordable disc (if you load a new blank
DVD-RW or DVD+RW disc, the recorder
takes a short while to initialize the disc).
• SP (Standard Play) – Default quality,
used for most applications, gives about
two hours of recording time on a DVD.
• If you want to record a VR mode DVD-R
or a Video mode DVD-RW, you must
initialize it before proceeding (see
Initializing recordable DVD discs on
page 72).
• LP (Long Play) – Lower video quality than
SP, but doubles the recording time on a
DVD to about four hours.
• EP (Extended Play) – Lower quality than
LP, but gives about six hours of
recording time on a DVD disc.
A.TV/D.TV
2
Press to switch between D.TV
(digital) and A.TV (analog).
Note
1 Audio is recorded in 16-bit Linear PCM format, video is recorded at XP quality. When recording a bilingual
broadcast, select which audio channel to record (see Bilingual Recording on page 132).
2 Applicable only to HDD recording. (If this setting is used when recording to DVD, MN32 is used.) When copied
to DVD, XP+ recordings are always copied in real time.
64
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
REC
CHANNEL
+
7
Start recording.
–
CHANNEL
3
Select a TV channel to record.
If you want to set a recording end time, press
the ꢀ REC button repeatedly. The recording
time increases in 30 minute increments, up
to a maximum of six hours. The time the
recording will end is shown on-screen and in
the front panel display. When the recording
ends, the recorder automatically switches
into standby if no other operation is being
performed.
The front panel display shows the channel
number, or channel name if it’s available:
A.TV Channel preset
• While the recorder is stopped, you can
also use the number buttons on the
remote to select the channel (For
channel 24, press 2, 4 then ENTER).
• To cancel the set recording time, press
ꢀ REC.
• If the recorder is stopped, you can also
use the CH +/– buttons on the front
panel to select the channel number.
REC MODE
• If you want to pause recording at any
1
time , press ꢅ PAUSE. Press again to
restart the recording (If recording to the
HDD, DVD-RAM or in VR mode, a new
chapter is started after recording
restarts).
4
Set the picture quality/recording
time.
• See Setting the picture quality/recording
time on page 64 for detailed instructions.
STOP REC
AUDIO
8
Press to stop recording.
• If you set the recording time in the
previous step, you can still stop the
recording anytime by pressing
ꢀ STOP REC.
5
If you’re recording from the A.TV
tuner, select the audio channel to record.
See Changing A.TV audio channels on
page 63 for more on this.
• When recording in VR mode, if a
broadcast is bilingual, both audio
channels are recorded, allowing you to
switch the audio channel on playback.
The only exception to this is when the
picture quality is set to LPCM, in which
case you do need to select the audio
channel before recording.
• Recording will stop automatically when
there is no more space on the HDD/
DVD, or after 12 hours of HDD recording
(whichever is sooner).
Tip
• During recording you can turn on/off the
SCART loop through function. During
recording, press the front panel CH +
button to switch to SCART THRU (loop
through on), or CH – to switch to SCART
NORM (loop through off). Loop through
is automatically reset to off after
recording has finished. Note that you
can’t switch loop through on if recording
from the AV1(RGB)-TV connector.
AUDIO
6
If you’re recording from the D.TV
tuner, select the audio language to
record.
• You may also be able to set which
subtitle language to record; use
SUBTITLE to select.
• Note that audio and subtitle languages
cannot be changed during the recording
of a digital broadcast.
Note
65
En
1 Except during Chase Play.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
1
Connect this recorder to your TV with
Pause Live TV
a SCART cable.
2
3
Press HOME MENU.
Select ‘Initial Setup’ > ‘Options2’ >
HDD
The Pause Live TV feature lets you effectively
pause a TV programme you’re watching.
When you’re ready to resume watching, just
press the ꢃ PLAY button.
‘Pause Live TV’ > ‘TV’s Tuner’.
4
Select ‘Initial Setup’ > ‘Analog Tuner’
> ‘Auto Channel Setting’ > ‘Download
from TV’.
• If the Download from TV option appears
grayed out, check the connections to
your TV and try again.
Setting up for Pause Live TV
You can use the Pause Live TV feature with
an AV Link-compatible TV connected using a
SCART cable (see TV tuner setup for Pause
Live TV below), or using this recorder’s
internal tuner (see Using the recorder’s
internal tuner for Pause Live TV below).
• Depending on your TV, you might have to
switch off and unplug it for a few
moments before plugging it back in and
switching it on again.
5
Follow the on-screen instructions.
TV tuner setup for Pause Live TV
To use this feature with an external TV tuner,
the recorder must be connected to your TV
using a SCART cable, and the AV. Link
setting (page 139) should be set to This
Using the recorder’s internal tuner for
Pause Live TV
If you haven’t connected to your TV using a
SCART cable (or your TV is not compatible
with AV Link) you can use the recorder’s
internal tuner for the Pause Live TV.
1
Recorder Only. See also Pause Live TV on
page 140 for more on this.
1
2
Press HOME MENU.
Select ‘Initial Setup’ > ‘Options2’ >
In order to use Pause Live TV, make the
following connections and settings.
‘Pause Live TV’ > ‘Recorder’s Tuner’.
• Pause Live TV will not work as expected
when watching TV via an external
component such as a VCR or digital
tuner. It only works with the channel
selected on the TV.
See Pause Live TV on page 140 to do this.
You can record the channel selected on the
recorder.
Important
• Pause Live TV only works with the built-in
A.TV (analog) tuner. It does not work with
the D.TV tuner or the external inputs.
Make sure the Auto Channel Setting is
set to Download from TV (see Auto
Channel Setting on page 130).
Note
1 • Not all TVs support this feature. Check the instructions that came with your TV if you are unsure.
• This feature will not work unless your TV is compatible with AV Link. See the operating instructions that came
with your TV if you’re unsure about your TV’s compatibility with this feature.
66
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
Using Pause Live TV
Tip
PAUSE
LIVE TV
• When the Pause Live TV setting (see
page 140) is set to TV’s Tuner, you can
press PAUSE LIVE TV while the recorder
is in standby to switch on and immediately
start recording. When set to Recorder’s
Tuner, it is not possible to use the Pause
Live TV feature from standby.
1
Start recording the current TV
channel.
Recording continues with playback paused.
• Note that it may take up to 10 seconds
for recording to start.
2
Press to start playback.
• After pressing PAUSE LIVE TV, it will
take at least 10 seconds for the picture to
change (during this time, all controls
except the power button are inoperative).
(Note that startup from standby is not
possible if you have selected Recorder’s
Tuner in Pause Live TV on page 140.)
• Please note that you can’t record from
another component (VCR, etc.) that is
connected by a SCART cable to the AV2
(INPUT 1/DECODER) connector using
the Pause Live TV feature.
You can also use the scan buttons (ꢈ/
ꢉ), pause (ꢅ PAUSE) and stop (ꢄ STOP)
— all without affecting the recording.
STOP REC
3
Press to stop the recording.
The operation is slightly different depending
on the viewing source. See the Operation
table below for details.
Operation table
TV/DVD
mode of DVR source
DVR
Pause Live TV
function button
Viewing source
Condition
TV built-in analog
tuner
TV
–
Pause Live TV
Preset channel of DVR and TV are
matched after downloading from TV.
Direct TV
recording*1
Preset channel of DVR and TV are NOT
matched after downloading from TV.
Record TV programme that you’re watching.
TV built-in digital
tuner
TV
–
–
Direct TV
recording*1
Preset channel info. in D.TV cannot be
shared by DVR even after Download from
TV. Record TV programme that you’re
watching.
External input of TV
TV
Direct TV
recording*1
Record TV programme that you’re
watching.
DVR built-in analog
tuner
DVD
DVD
DVR built-in Pause Live TV
analog tuner
DVR built-in digital
tuner
DVR built-in Pause Live TV
digital tuner
*1 No Chase Play! Warning if you change input this will stop the recording.
67
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
About timer recordings
Important
• A timer recording can’t be set if there are
already 32 timer programmes waiting to
be recorded.
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
Using the timer recording features you can
program up to 32 timer recordings up to a
month in advance. Timer recording
programmes can be set to record just once,
every day, or every week.
• Timer recording will not start if:
– The recorder is already recording.
– A disc is being initialized, finalized or
unfinalized.
• Timer recording will start when the
operation preventing timer recording
has finished.
You can set the recording quality for your
timer recording in the same way as for a
regular recording, but with the added option
of an AUTO mode, which maximizes the
recording quality for the space available on
the disc (if recording to DVD), or to fit on to a
blank DVD disc (if recording to the HDD).
• When the front panel display is set to
ON, the timer indicator ( ) lights in the
front panel display when the timer is
active. If the indicator is blinking it
means that (for a DVD timer recording)
there is no disc loaded, or the disc
loaded is not recordable (for an HDD
timer recording it means that the HDD is
not recordable).
You can set timer recordings to record to a
recordable DVD or to the hard disk drive. For
regular (daily or weekly) HDD timer
recordings that you don’t need to keep, you
can use the Auto Replace Recording feature
to automatically replace the previous timer
recording with the new one. Note that when
you use this feature, the previous recording
made on that timer programme will be
replaced by the next one, regardless of
whether you have watched it yet or not.
• Approximately two minutes before a
timer recording is set to start, the
recorder will go into timer recording
standby. In timer recording standby you
cannot use some functions.
• The maximum length for timer
You can also set the recorder so that it will
adjust the recording quality to try and fit the
recording on to the disc if it would not
otherwise fit at the recording quality you set
(see Optimized Rec on page 135 for more on
this).
recordings made to the HDD is 24 hours.
However, because one title (HDD) is
limited to 12 hours, recordings over 12
hours will be spread over two titles. Note
that there will be a break in the recording
of a few seconds between titles.
Finally, if you set a timer recording to record
to DVD but there isn’t a recordable DVD
loaded at the time of the recording, the
Recovery Recording feature will
automatically record the programme to the
HDD for you.
• VPS/PDC works only with analog
stations; it does not work with digital TV
stations.
• VPS/PDC may not work with all
broadcast stations in your country/area.
Check with the stations for compatibility.
This recorder is compatible with VPS (Video
Programming System) and PDC
(Programme Delivery Control) systems used
by many analog TV stations to ensure that a
timer recording catches the whole
programme even when the programme is
not running to schedule. Up to eight timer
programmes can be set with VPS/PDC on.
• The hours between 3:00 and 5:00 in the
morning are used by the GUIDE Plus+
system to download programme
information. During these times, VPS/
PDC may not work reliably; leave VPS/
PDC off if you set a timer recording for
these times.
68
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
• If VPS/PDC is active for two timer
programmes that are programmed to
start at the same time, then the
programme that actually starts first
takes priority.
2
[Front panel] Press and hold for
three seconds to lock the controls.
The front panel display briefly shows
LOCKED. If any buttons are pressed on the
remote or front panel, LOCKED is briefly
displayed again.
Extending a timer recording in
progress
• To unlock the recorder, press and hold
ꢄ (Stop) on the front panel (while the
recorder is stopped) for three seconds
until the display shows UNLOCKED.
You can extend a timer recording beyond the
programmed end time. This can be useful if
a broadcast programme overruns, for
example.
Timer recording FAQ
Cancelling or extending the timer
Frequently Asked Questions
REC
• Even though the timer is set, the recorder
doesn’t start recording!
1
Press and hold for three seconds
during a timer recording.
Recording continues, but the timer indicator
disappears from the front panel display
indicating that the timer has been cancelled.
Check that the disc loaded or HDD is
recordable, not locked (see Lock Disc on
page 121), and that there are fewer than
99/999 titles already on the DVD/HDD.
REC
• The recorder won’t let me enter a timer
programme! Why not?
You can’t enter a timer programme if the
clock isn’t set.
• What happens when two or more timer
programmes overlap?
2
Press repeatedly to extend
recording in 30 minute blocks.
Stopping a timer recording
STOP REC
Basically, the programme with the earlier
recording start time has priority.
1
Press during a timer recording.
However, the recorder will start recording
the programme with the later start time
after the earlier programme is finished. If
schedule to record two programmes
have the same times (but different
channels, for example), then only one of
the two programmes will be recorded. In
this event you should cancel the
ENTER
2
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm.
Preventing use of the recorder
before a timer recording (child
lock)
You can make all the front panel and remote
control buttons inoperative using the child
lock feature. This is useful when you set a
timer recording and want to make sure that
the timer settings are not changed before
recording has finished.
scheduled recording of the lesser
important programme. If one of the
overlapping programmes is a regular
timer programme for a digital broadcast,
you may choose ‘Cancel Once’ in order
to avoid having it overlap with a
separately scheduled programme (see
Skipping a regular timer programme on
STANDBY/ON
ꢂ
1
If the recorder is on, switch it
page 56)
.
into standby.
69
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
Also, during simultaneous recording
and playback, if the TV line system of the
playback track/title changes then
playback will automatically stop.
Simultaneous recording and
playback (Chase Play)
HDD
Recording from an external
component
Chase Play allows you to watch a recording
that is still in progress from the start, without
having to wait until the recording has
finished (i.e., playback is ‘chasing’ the
recording).
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
You can record from an external component,
such as a camcorder or VCR, connected to
one of the recorder’s external inputs.
In fact, you’re not just limited to watching
the recording in progress. You can watch
anything else already on the HDD (or on a
DVD if you’re recording to the HDD) by
selecting it from the Disc Navigator screen
(see Using the Disc Navigator with recordable
discs and the HDD on page 78).
1
Make sure that the component you
want to record from is connected
properly to the HDD/DVD recorder.
See Chapter 2 (Connecting up) for
connection options.
Chase Play is not possible when DV is the
recording input.
INPUT SELECT
2
Press repeatedly to select one of
•
Press during recording to start
the external inputs to record from.
The current input is shown on-screen and in
the front panel display:
playback from the beginning of the
1
current recording .
2
• AV2/L1 – Input 1
DISC
•
Press during recording to select
NAVIGATOR
• L2 – Input 2 (front panel)
another title to play.
• L3 – Input 3
You can use all the usual playback controls,
such as pause, slow-motion play, scan and
skip.
Check that the Audio In settings for
External Audio and Bilingual Recording
are as you want them (see Audio In on
page 132).
• To stop playback, press ꢄ STOP
(recording will continue).
• If the aspect ratio is distorted (squashed
or stretched), adjust on the source
component or your TV before recording.
• To stop recording, press ꢀ STOP REC
(playback will continue).
• During recording or in timer recording
standby, you can’t play an HDD title,
DVD or Video CD/Super VCD disc if the
Input Line System setting doesn’t match
the TV line system of the disc/HDD title
(see also Additional information about
the TV system settings on page 141).
• To watch video coming in via the DV
input (front panel), select DV > DV
Video Playback from the Home Menu
(see also Playing from a DV camcorder on
page 85).
REC MODE
3
Set the recording quality.
• See Setting the picture quality/recording
time on page 64 for detailed information.
Note
1 You can’t start playback immediately after recording starts. Simultaneous playback and recording doesn’t work
while copying or backing up.
2 This cannot be selected if AV2/L1 In is set to Decoder (see AV2/L1 In on page 132).
70
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
HDD/DVD
Finalizing a disc
4
Select the HDD or DVD for
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW
recording.
REC
Finalizing ‘fixes’ the recordings on the disc
so that it can be played on a regular DVD
player or computer equipped with a suitable
5
Press to start recording.
• If your source is copy-protected using
Copy Guard, you will not be able to
record it. See Restrictions on video
recording on page 61 for more details.
1
DVD-ROM drive.
Note that the disc name will appear in the
title menu after you finalize a disc. Make sure
the disc name is as you want it before you
finalize the disc as it can’t be changed
afterwards. If you want to rename the disc,
see Input Disc Name on page 121 before
starting the steps below.
Playing your recordings on
other DVD players
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW
DVD+RW discs don’t generally need
finalizing. However, if you want a title menu
to appear when you play the disc, then you
will need to finalize. When using a
DVD+RW, you can still record and edit even
after finalizing. although the title menu will
disappear if you do so. Finalize the disc
again to generate a new title menu.
Most regular DVD players can play finalized
discs recorded in DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)
and DVD+R discs. A number of players
(including many Pioneer models) can also
play DVD-RW discs recorded in VR mode,
finalized or not. Most players will not play VR
mode DVD-R discs, although some DVD-
ROM drives and DVD recorders may be able
to (finalization might be necessary). Check
the manual that came with the player to
check what kinds of discs it will play.
Important
• Once you’ve finalized a DVD-R/-RW
(Video mode) or DVD+R disc, you can’t
edit or record anything else on that disc.
However, the finalization on a DVD-RW
disc maybe ‘undone’; see Undo Finalize
on page 122 for how to do this.
When you finalize a DVD-R/-RW (Video
mode) or DVD+R disc, a title menu is
created from which you can select titles
when you play the disc. There are a number
of different styles of title menu to choose
from to suit the content of the disc.
• A VR mode DVD-R/-RW (excluding DVD-
R DL) disc can still be recorded and
edited on this recorder even after
finalizing.
All the title menus are navigated in the usual
way, pressing MENU or TOP MENU to
display the menu, then using the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/
ꢀ followed by ENTER to select titles and
start playback.
• DVD-R DL (Video mode) discs and
DVD+R DL discs must be finalized in
order to play in other recorders/players.
Note however that some recorders/
players will not play even finalized dual-
layer discs.
Note
1 If the TV line system of the disc is different to the current setting of the recorder, you will not be able to finalize
the disc. See Additional information about the TV system settings on page 141 for how to change the recorder’s
setting.
71
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
1
Load the disc you want to finalize.
5
The recorder will now start finalizing
Make sure that the recorder is stopped
the disc.
before proceeding.
During finalization:
2
HOME MENU
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
• If the finalization process of a DVD-RW
or DVD+R/+RW disc is going to take
more than around four minutes, you can
press ENTER to cancel. Around four
minutes before completion, the option to
cancel disappears.
Home Menu.
ENTER
3
Select ‘Finalize’ > ‘Finalize’ >
‘Next Screen’.
• You can’t cancel the finalization of a VR
mode DVD-R disc.
Disc Setup
Next Screen
Start
Basic
Finalize
Undo Finalize
Initialize
Finalize
• How long finalization takes depends on
the type of disc, how much is recorded
on the disc and the number of titles on
the disc. A disc recorded in VR mode can
take up to one hour to finalize. DVD-R/
-RW (Video mode) and DVD+R/+RW
discs can take up to 20 minutes.
Optimize HDD
ENTER
4
For DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)
Initializing recordable DVD
discs
and DVD+R/+RW discs only, select a title
menu style, then select ‘Yes’ to start
finalization or ‘No’ to cancel.
The menu you select will be the one that
appears when the ‘top menu’ (or ‘menu’ for
a DVD+R/+RW) is selected on any DVD
player.
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+RW DVD-RAM
DVD-R/-RW discs can be initialized for either
Video mode recording or VR mode
1
recording.
Finalize
When you first load a blank DVD-RW or
DVD+RW disc, the recorder initializes it for
recording automatically. By default, blank
DVD-RW discs are initialized for VR mode
recording. See DVD-RW Auto Initialize on
page 73 if you want to change the default to
Video mode.
• Discs recorded partially or fully on the
Pioneer DVR-7000 DVD recorder do not
support this feature. These discs will
have only a text title menu when finalized
on this recorder.
DVD-R discs are ready for Video mode
recordings out of the box; if you want to use
a DVD-R for VR mode recording, you must
initialize it before recording anything on the
disc.
DVD+RW and DVD-RAM discs can also be
initialized in order to erase the contents of
the disc.
Note
1 If a disc was previously finalized on an older DVD recorder, you may not be able to re-initialize and/or initialize
it for Video mode recording.
72
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
07
DVD-RW Auto Initialize
Important
• Initializing a DVD-RW, DVD+RW or
DVD-RAM disc will erase everything
recorded on it. Make sure there is
nothing on the disc that you want to
keep!
DVD-RW
• Default setting: VR Mode
Initialization mode is automatically carried
out when you insert a blank DVD-RW. You
must set the desired initialization mode
before inserting a disc.
• You may not be able to re-initialize a
DVD-RW disc in a different format if it
was originally initialized on an older DVD
recorder.
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
• Once initialized for VR mode recording,
you can’t re-initialize a DVD-R back to
Video mode.
Home Menu.
ENTER
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
2
Select ‘Basic’>’DVD-RW Auto
Home Menu.
Init.’, then ‘VR Mode’ or ‘Video Mode’.
Disc Setup
ENTER
VR Mode
Basic
Input Disc Name
Lock Disc
2
Select ‘Initialize’ > ‘Video
Video Mode
Initialize
Finalize
DVD-RW Auto Init.
Mode’, ‘VR Mode’ or ‘Initialize
DVD+RW’.
Optimize HDD
Disc Setup
Start
Start
Start
Basic
VR Mode
Initialize
Finalize
Video Mode
Initialize DVD+RW
Optimize HDD
ENTER
3
Select ‘Start’.
It takes about 30 seconds to initialize the
disc (except DVD-RAM discs, which can take
up to an hour).
Initializing Disc
Pr 1
1 min left
73
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
CPhlaapteyr b8 ack
• Some DVD-Video, DVD+R and
DVD+RW discs don’t allow certain
playback controls to operate at certain
points in the disc. This is not a
malfunction.
Introduction
Most of the features described in this
chapter make use of on-screen displays.
Navigate these using the cursor buttons and
ENTER. To go back one level from any
screen, use the RETURN/EXIT button.
HDD/DVD
1
Select the HDD or DVD for
playback.
• If playing video from the HDD, skip to
step 3 below.
Remember also that the button guide at the
bottom of every screen shows which buttons
do what.
Many of the functions covered in this
chapter apply to the HDD, DVD discs, Video
CDs, Super VCDs, WMA/MP3/DivX discs
and CDs, although the exact operation of
some varies slightly with the kind of disc
loaded.
• Select DVD for any kind of disc playback.
OPEN/CLOSE
2
[Front panel] Load a disc.
Load a disc with the label side facing up,
using the disc tray guide to align the disc (if
you’re loading a double-sided DVD-Video
disc, load it with the side you want to play
face down).
• Many functions are not available when a
Video CD is playing in PBC mode. Start
playback from the Disc Navigator screen
for non-PBC playback (see Using the
Disc Navigator with playback-only discs
on page 79).
• If you want to play a DTS audio CD,
please first read the note on page 76.
3
Start playback.
• If you’re playing a DVD-Video or Video
CD, a disc menu may appear when you
start playback. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ
buttons, number buttons, and ENTER to
navigate DVD disc menus, and the
number buttons and ENTER for Video
CD menus.
• For discs that contain JPEG picture files,
see The PhotoViewer on page 113.
Basic playback
A L L
• When playing video from the HDD,
playback will automatically stop after the
end of a title is reached.
This section shows you how to use your
recorder for playback of discs (DVD, CD,
etc.), and for playback of video from the
HDD.
• There may be a slight pause when
playback switches from the first to the
second layer of a dual-layer disc.
Important
• See the following sections for more
details on playing specific kinds of discs.
• Throughout this manual, the term ‘DVD’
means any kind of playable or recordable
DVD. If a function is specific to a
particular kind of DVD disc, it is
specified.
STOP
4
5
Press to stop playback.
When you’ve finished using the
recorder, eject the disc and switch the
recorder back into standby.
74
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Playing DVD discs
ꢊ/
/ꢍ
While paused, press and hold
to start slow-motion playback.
Press repeatedly to change the
playback speed.
The table below shows the basic playback
controls for DVD-Video, and recordable DVD
discs.
While paused, press to advance
a single frame in either direc-
tion. You can also execute
frame-by-frame playback/back-
ward scanning via the
Press to start playback.
If RESUME is displayed on-
screen, playback starts from
the place last stopped.
Smart Jog.
Press to stop playback.
STOP
You can resume playback from
the same point by pressing
ꢃ PLAY. (Press ꢄ STOP again
to cancel the resume function.)
TOP MENU
Press to display the menu of a
DVD-Video disc. (DVD+R/+RW
discs finalized on this recorder
will display the Disc Navigator.
Press MENU to display the disc
menu.)
MENU
DISC
NAVIGATOR
PAUSE
Pauses playback, or restarts
playback when paused.
Use the cursor buttons to navi-
gate DVD-Video disc menus;
press ENTER to select items.
Press to start scanning. Press
repeatedly to increase the scan-
ning speed.
ENTER
RETURN/EXIT
PREV
NEXT
Press to return to the previous
level of a DVD-Video disc menu.
Press to skip to previous/next
chapter/title. (During playback
you can also use the front panel
CH +/– buttons.)
DVD+R/DVD+RW only:
ꢆ PREV may not always skip
to the previous title.
Playing from the HDD
The table below shows the basic playback
controls when playing video recorded on the
hard disk (HDD).
Except VR mode: During play-
back, enter a chapter number
then press ENTER to skip
directly to that chapter within
the currently playing title.
On some discs, you can also
use the number buttons to
select numbered items in the
disc menu.
VR mode only: During playback,
enter a title number then press
ENTER.
All: Press CLEAR to clear a
number entry and start again.
Press to start playback.
If RESUME is displayed on-
screen, playback starts from
the place last stopped. Play-
back automatically stops after
the end of a title is reached.
CLEAR CLEAR
ENTER
Press to stop playback.
You can resume playback from
the same point by pressing
ꢃ PLAY. (Press ꢄ STOP again
to cancel the resume function.)
STOP
PAUSE
Pauses playback, or restarts
playback when paused.
(Commercial back/skip)
CM BACK
CM SKIP
Press to start scanning. Press
repeatedly to increase the scan-
ning speed.
Turn the Smart Jog counter-
clockwise for backward skip;
turn clockwise for forward skip.
You can search up to two hours
in either direction.
75
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
PREV
NEXT
Press to skip to previous/next
chapter/title. (During playback
you can also use the front panel
CH +/– buttons.)
Except WMA: Press to start
scanning. Press again to
increase the scanning speed.
(There are two scan speeds; the
current scan speed is shown
on-screen.)
During playback, enter a title
number then press ENTER to
skip directly to that title.
Press CLEAR to clear a number
entry and start again.
PREV
NEXT
Press to skip to previous/next
track (or folder for WMA/MP3
disc). (During playback you can
also use the front panel CH +/–
buttons.)
CLEAR CLEAR
ENTER
During playback, enter a track
number then press ENTER to
skip directly to that track.
Press CLEAR to clear a number
entry and start again.
(Commercial back/skip)
CM BACK
CM SKIP
Turn the Smart Jog counter-
clockwise for backward skip;
turn clockwise for forward skip.
You can search up to two hours
in either direction.
CLEAR CLEAR
ENTER
ꢊ/
/ꢍ
While paused, press and hold
to start slow-motion playback.
Press repeatedly to change the
playback speed.
Playing Video CD/Super VCDs
The table below shows the basic playback
controls for Video CD/Super VCDs.
While paused, press to advance
a single frame in either direc-
tion. You can also execute
frame-by-frame playback/back-
ward scanning via the
Some discs feature Playback Control (PBC
for short) menus. These discs show PBC in
the display when you load them and display
a menu on-screen from where you can select
Smart Jog.
2
what to watch.
Press to start playback.
Video CD only: If RESUME is dis-
played on-screen, playback
starts from the place last
stopped.
Playing CDs and WMA/MP3 discs
The table below shows the basic playback
1
controls for audio CDs , and WMA/MP3
files.
Press to start playback.
Press to stop playback.
STOP
Video CD only: You can resume
playback from the same point
by pressing ꢃ PLAY. (Press
ꢄ STOP again to cancel the
resume function.)
Press to stop playback.
STOP
PAUSE
Pauses playback, or restarts
playback when paused.
Note
1 If you want to play a DTS audio CD, make sure the recorder is connected to a DTS-compatible amp/receiver with
a digital connection. Noise will be output through the analog outputs. Also make sure that STEREO is selected
using the
AUDIO button (see Switching audio channels on page 83).
2 When playing in PBC mode, some playback features, such as search, repeat and programme play are not
available. You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD in non-PBC mode by starting playback using the Disc
Navigator (see Using the Disc Navigator with playback-only discs on page 79).
76
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Playing DivX video files
PAUSE
Pauses playback, or restarts
The table below shows the basic playback
controls for DivX video files.
playback when paused.
Press to start scanning. Press
repeatedly to increase the scan-
ning speed.
Press to start playback.
If RESUME is displayed on-
screen, playback starts from
the place last stopped. Play-
back of titles (DivX files) pro-
ceeds in alphabetical order.
PREV
NEXT
Press to skip to previous/next
track.
When a PBC menu is dis-
played, press to display the pre-
vious/next page. (During
playback you can also use the
front panel CH +/– buttons.)
Press to stop playback.
STOP
You can resume playback from
the same point by pressing
ꢃ PLAY. (Press ꢄ STOP again
to cancel the resume function.)
During playback, enter a track
number then press ENTER to
skip directly to that track.
Press CLEAR to clear a number
entry and start again.
While a PBC menu screen is
displayed, use to select num-
bered menu items.
PAUSE
Pauses playback, or restarts
playback when paused.
CLEAR CLEAR
ENTER
Press to start scanning. Press
repeatedly to increase the scan-
ning speed.
PREV
NEXT
Press to skip to previous/next
title. (During playback you can
also use the front panel CH +/–
buttons.)
Video CD in non-PBC mode only:
(Commercial back/skip)
CM BACK
CM SKIP
Turn the Smart Jog counter-
clockwise for backward skip;
turn clockwise for forward skip.
You can search up to two hours
in either direction.
/ꢍ
While paused, press to advance
one frame. Press and hold to
start slow motion playback
(press repeatedly to change the
slow motion play speed). You
can also execute frame-by-
frame playback via the
/ꢍ
While paused, press and hold
to start slow-motion playback.
Press repeatedly to change the
playback speed (forward only).
While paused, press to advance
a single frame (forward only).
You can also execute frame-by-
frame playback via the
Smart Jog.
AUDIO
Press to display the playback
audio type; press repeatedly to
change the playback audio
type.
Smart Jog.
RETURN/EXIT
Press to display the disc menu
of a Video CD/Super VCD play-
ing in PBC mode.
SUBTITLE
Press to display subtitle
information; press repeatedly to
change subtitles.
77
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Using the Disc Navigator to
browse the contents of a disc
ENTER
4
Play the highlighted title.
• You can also select Play from the
command menu options.
Use the Disc Navigator to browse the
contents of a disc and start playback.
Changing the display style of the
Disc Navigator
Using the Disc Navigator with
recordable discs and the HDD
You can choose to display titles in the Disc
Navigator in various different ways, sorted
alphabetically, by recording date, by genre,
and so on. You can also choose whether to
display four or eight titles on the screen at
the same time.
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
You can use the Disc Navigator to browse
and edit video on recordable DVDs and the
HDD, and to view information on titles.
See also Editing on page 88 for more on
editing recordable discs.
1
Display the View Options
panel.
HDD/DVD
1
2
Select the HDD or DVD.
Open the Disc Navigator.
The View Options panel
DISC
NAVIGATOR
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
4
SP
SP
Style
4
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10
Titles
10Titles
2h00m(1.0G)
Sort order
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
4
SP
SP
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
SP
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
SP
2h00m(1.0G)
SP
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Recent first
2h00m(1.0G)
MENU
4
Titles
Genre
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
SP
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
SP
2h00m(1.0G)
SP
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
All Genres
Recent first
All Genres
MENU
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
Remain
30h30m
1h00m(1.0G)
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
30h30m
ENTER
• You can also access the Disc Navigator
from the Home Menu.
2
Choose ‘Style’, ‘Sort order’ or
‘Genre’, then press ENTER to see the
available view options.
• Style – Select four or eight titles per
screen view
3
Browse the list of titles.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
• Sort order – Sort by date (most recent
first), unwatched first, title name or
recording date (oldest first)
• Use the ꢆ PREV/ꢇ NEXT buttons to
display the previous/next page of titles.
• Genre – Display all genres or just a
• To change the thumbnail picture
displayed for a title see Set Thumbnail on
page 93.
selected genre
ENTER
3
Choose a view option, then
• For HDD recordings, you should be able
to see a thumbnail title digest. If it
doesn’t display, set Set Preview to
Normal. See Set Preview on page 139.
press ENTER.
The title list display is updated according to
the new display preferences.
78
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Using the Disc Navigator with
playback-only discs
1
During playback, start reverse
or forward scanning.
• The scanning speed is shown on-screen.
WMA/MP3
DVD-Video CD Video CD Super VCD
DivX
2
Press repeatedly to change the
scanning speed.
HOME MENU
1
Display the Home Menu.
There are four scanning speeds available
when playing HDD video, a DVD or a DivX
title. Reverse playback is also possible with
ENTER
2
Select ‘Disc Navigator’.
2
HDD and DVD video.
Alternatively, for a CD, Video CD, Super VCD
or WMA/MP3/DivX disc, you can press DISC
NAVIGATOR, which takes you straight to
the Disc Navigator screen.
There are two scanning speeds for other
types of disc.
3
Resume normal playback.
ENTER
3
Select what you want to play.
Playing in slow motion
Depending on the type of disc you have loaded,
the Disc Navigator looks slightly different, but
they are all navigated in the same way.
DVD HDD Video CD Super VCD DivX
The screen below shows a WMA/MP3/DivX
disc. Navigate to the folder, or the track/title
within a folder that you want to play.
You can play video at various slow motion
speeds. DVDs and video on the HDD can be
played in slow motion in either direction,
while Video CDs/Super VCDs and DivX titles
can only be played forwards in slow motion.
Disc Navigator
Folder (01-03)
01.Rock
Track(001-004)
001.Intro
CD
There is no sound when playing in slow
motion.
WMA/MP3
Divx
02.Pop
03.Dance
002.Escape
003.Everything You Say
004.What I Do
PAUSE
1
2
Pause playback.
ꢊ/
/ꢍ
Press and hold to start slow
Playback starts after you press ENTER.
motion reverse or forward play.
• For discs that contain CD-Audio tracks
and WMA/MP3 tracks or DivX titles, you
can switch the playback area between
CD, WMA/MP3 and DivX. This can only
be done while the disc is stopped.
ꢊ/
/ꢍ
3
Press repeatedly to change
the slow motion speed.
The current playback speed is indicated on-
screen.
4
Resume normal playback.
Scanning discs
A L L
(except WMA)
You can scan discs at various speeds,
1
forwards or backwards.
Note
1 • No subtitles are displayed when scanning DVDs and DivX titles.
• No sound is output when scanning from the HDD, DVDs and DivX, except on forward SCAN 1.
• Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatically resume when a new chapter is reached on a DVD
disc.
79
En
2 Reverse playback may not be smooth.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Frame advance/frame
reverse
ENTER
1
Select ‘Search Mode’ from the
Play Mode menu, then choose a search
option.
DVD HDD Video CD Super VCD DivX
The available search options depend on the
type of disc.
You can advance or back up video on a DVD
disc or the HDD frame-by-frame.
1
With Video CDs/Super VCDs and DivX titles,
you can only use frame advance.
2
Enter a title/chapter/folder/
PAUSE
track number or a search time.
1
2
Pause playback.
Play Mode
ꢊ/
/ꢍ
Time Search
Title Search
Input Time
0.01.00
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Back up or advance one
Chapter Search
frame with each press.
• You can also do this by rotating the
Smart Jog.
Programme
3
Resume normal playback.
Time Search (HDD, DVD): For example, for 25
minutes into the current title, press 2, 5, 0, 0.
For 1 hour and 15 minutes and 20 seconds
into the title, press 1, 1, 5, 2, 0.
The Play Mode menu
Time Search (Video CD): For example, for
2 minutes and 30 seconds into the current
track, press 2, 3, 0.
A L L
The Play Mode menu gives you access to
search functions, repeat and programme
play functions.
Title/Chapter/Folder/Track Search: For
example, for track 6, press 6.
HOME MENU
•
Select ‘Play Mode’ from the
ENTER
3
Start playback.
Home Menu.
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Time Search
Title Search
Chapter Search
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
DVD HDD CD Video CD DivX
Programme
The A-B Repeat function allows you to
specify two points (A and B) within a track or
title that form a loop which is played over
3
Search Mode
and over.
A L L
ENTER
The Search Mode feature lets you start
1
During playback, select ‘A-B
playback from a specified point in a disc by
Repeat’ from the Play Mode menu.
2
time or by title/chapter/folder/track
number.
Note
1 Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatically resume when a new chapter is reached.
2 When using time search, playback may occasionally start slightly before or after the time you input.
3 If you switch camera angles on a DVD during A-B repeat play, A-B repeat is cancelled.
80
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
ENTER
2
With ‘A (Loop Start)’
ENTER
•
Select ‘Repeat’ from the Play
highlighted, press at the point you want
the loop to start.
Mode menu, then choose a repeat play
mode.
Play Mode
A (Loop Start)
B (Loop End)
Off
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Play Mode
Repeat Title
Repeat Chapter
Repeat Off
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Programme
Programme
ENTER
3
With ‘B (Loop End)’ highlighted,
• To resume normal playback, select
Repeat Off from the Repeat Play menu,
or press CLEAR if no menu OSD (such as
the Play Mode menu) is displayed.
press at the point you want the loop to
end.
Playback immediately jumps back to the
start point and plays the loop round and
round.
Programme play
• When playing a DVD-Video, DVD-R/-RW
(Video mode), DVD+R/+RW, or from
the HDD, the start and end points of the
loop must be in the same title.
WMA/MP3
HDD DVD-Video CD Video CD Super VCD
This feature lets you program the play order
2
of titles/chapters /folders/tracks on a disc or
• To resume normal playback, select Off
from the A-B Repeat menu, or press
CLEAR if no menu OSD (such as the Play
Mode menu) is displayed.
the HDD.
ENTER
1
Select ‘Programme’ from the
Play Mode menu, then ‘Input/Edit
Programme’.
The Input/Edit Programme screen varies
according to the disc type. Below is the DVD
input screen.
Repeat play
A L L
There are various repeat play options,
depending on the kind of disc loaded, or if
you’re using the HDD for playback. It’s also
possible to use repeat play together with
programme play to repeat the tracks/
chapters in the programme list (see
Programme
Step
01.001
02.
03.
04.
05.
06.
07.
08.
Title (01-03)
Title 01
Title 02
Chapter(001-015)
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
Chapter 004
Chapter 005
Chapter 006
Chapter 007
Chapter 008
Title 03
1
Programme play below).
ENTER
2
Select a title, chapter, folder
or track for the current step in the
programme list.
Note
1 If you switch the camera angle during repeat play of a DVD-Video disc, repeat play is cancelled.
2 When playing a programme list of DVD-Video chapters, chapters not included in the programme list may be
sometimes be played, depending on the disc.
81
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
After pressing ENTER to add the title/
chapter/folder/track, the step number
automatically moves down one.
• From the programme menu you can
also:
Start Programme Play – Starts
playback of a saved programme list
Cancel Programme Play – Turns off
programme play, but does not erase the
programme list
Erase Programme List – Erases the
programme list and turns off
programme play
• To insert a step into the programme list,
highlight the step number where you
want to insert another step, then select a
chapter/title/folder/track as usual. After
pressing ENTER, all the subsequent
steps move down one.
• To delete a step from the programme list,
highlight the step you want to delete,
then press CLEAR.
Displaying and switching
subtitles
3
Repeat step 2 to build up a
programme list.
A programme list can contain up to 24 titles/
chapters/folders/tracks.
DVD-Video DivX
Some DVD and DivX discs have subtitles in
one or more languages; the disc box will
usually tell you which subtitle languages are
available. You can switch subtitle language
4
Play the programme list.
Programme play remains active until you
cancel programme play, erase the
programme list, eject the disc or switch off
the recorder.
1
during playback.
Check the disc packaging for details of the
subtitle options.
Tip
SUBTITLE
• To save your programme list and exit the
programme edit screen without starting
playback, press HOME MENU.
•
Select/change the subtitle
language.
The current subtitle language is shown on-
screen and in the front panel display.
• During programme play, press ꢇ
NEXT to skip to the next programme
step.
• To switch off subtitles, press
SUBTITLE then CLEAR.
• To repeat play the programme list, select
Programme Repeat from the Repeat
Play Mode menu (see Repeat play on
page 81).
Switching DVD and DivX
soundtracks
• Press CLEAR during playback to switch
off programme play (if no menu OSD,
such as the Disc Navigator, is
DVD-Video DivX
displayed). Press while stopped to erase
the programme list.
When playing a DVD disc or DivX title
recorded with two or more soundtracks
(often in different languages), you can
2
switch the soundtrack during playback.
Note
1 • Some discs only allow you to change subtitle language from the disc menu. Press MENU or TOP MENU to
access.
• To set subtitle preferences, see Subtitle Language on page 134.
2 • Some discs only allow you to change audio language from the disc menu. Press MENU or TOP MENU to
access.
82
En
• To set audio language preferences, see Audio Language on page 134.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Check the disc packaging for details of the
soundtrack options.
HDD DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
L+R – Both channels (default)
L – Left channel only
R – Right channel only
AUDIO
•
Change the audio soundtrack.
The current audio language is shown on-
screen and in the front panel display.
WMA/MP3
CD Video CD
• The sound may drop out for a few
seconds when switching soundtracks.
Stereo – Stereo (default)
1/L – Left channel only
2/R – Right channel only
• Some discs feature both Dolby Digital
and DTS soundtracks. There is no analog
audio output when DTS is selected. To
listen to the DTS soundtrack, connect
this recorder to a DTS decoder or AV
amp/receiver with built-in DTS decoder
via the digital output. See Connecting to
an AV amplifier/receiver on page 20 for
connection details.
Super VCD
1 Stereo – Soundtrack 1/Stereo (default)
1 L – Soundtrack 1/Left channel
1 R – Soundtrack 1/Right channel
2 Stereo – Soundtrack 2/Stereo
2 L – Soundtrack 2/Left channel
2 R – Soundtrack 2/Right channel
Switching audio channels
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM HDD CD Video CD Super VCD
WMA/MP3
Switching camera angles
DVD-Video
1
For HDD and VR mode content recorded
Some DVD-Video discs feature scenes shot
from two or more angles — check the disc
box for details: it should be marked with a
icon if it contains multi-angle scenes.
When a multi-angle scene is playing, the
same icon appears on screen to let you know
that other angles are available (this can be
switched off if you prefer — see Angle
Indicator on page 137).
with bilingual audio, you can switch between
left (L) channel, right (R) channel, or both
2
(L+R).
When playing Video CDs and audio CDs you
can switch between stereo, just the left
channel or just the right channel.
Some Super VCDs have two soundtracks.
With these discs you can switch between the
two soundtracks as well as individual
channels in each.
ANGLE
•
Switch the camera angle.
• The angle number is displayed on-
screen.
AUDIO
•
Press repeatedly to display/switch
the audio channel.
The audio channel(s) currently playing are
indicated on-screen.
• If the disc was paused, playback starts
again with the new angle.
Note
1 Only when HDD Recording Format is set to Video Mode Off (HDD Recording Format on page 136).
2 When playing a Bilingual recording on a VR mode disc, if you are listening to the Dolby Digital soundtrack via
the digital output, you cannot switch the audio channel. Set Dolby Digital Out to Dolby Digital ꢄ PCM (see
Dolby Digital Out on page 133) or listen via the analog outputs if you need to switch the audio channel.
83
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playback
08
Shows recording restrictions for
the current channel programme
Displaying disc information
on-screen
ꢄStop
DVD-RW VR
Original
ABC Pr 1
Stereo
Copy Once
Resume
You can display various on-screen
information about the disc loaded or the
HDD.
XP (1h00m/DVD)
Finalized
Rem. 0h35m
Disc Name
:
Comedy shows
DVD Mode
DISPLAY
Indicates copy-protected material
Indicates a multi-angle scene
•
Display/change the on-screen
information.
ꢃPlay
3–2
0. 00. 15
!
• Press once to show the HDD and
removable disc (DVD, etc.) activity
together. Press again to show the status
of just the currently selected playback/
recording device (HDD or removable
disc).
DVD-R Video Chapter Time 0. 00. 21
Chapter Total 0h01m52s
ꢅꢅꢅꢅꢅꢅꢅ
4.32Mbps
Title Name
:
21/11 Football match
Indicates the data transfer rate
• To hide the information display, press
DISPLAY repeatedly until it disappears.
Tip
• See Switching camera angles on page 83
for more on multi-angle scene
switching.
HDD and removable disc activity
display
Press DISPLAY once to see the HDD and
removable disc (DVD, etc.) activity. Use the
HDD/DVD button to switch between the two
kinds of display.
• When using the simultaneous play and
record feature, the display shows
information for playback only.
• During real-time copy, the copy source
playback information is displayed.
The example displays below show high-
speed copying from HDD to DVD, and HDD
chase playback.
• The Video mode DVD-R/-RW displays
become the same as a DVD-Video disc
once the disc is finalized.
Rec Mode SP(2h00m/DVD)
• The total recording time figure shown in
parenthesis is calculated based on a
12 cm/4.7 GB disc at the displayed
record setting.
HDD
Hi-Speed Copy
HDD ꢄ DVD
DVD-RW Video
Remain 10h35m
Stop
Remain –h––m
Stop
0h08m left
• Recording and playback times for TV
recordings are approximately 0.1 %
shorter than the actual time. This is
because of the slightly different frame
rates of TV broadcasts versus DVD.
Rec Mode SP(2h00m/DVD)
HDD
DVD-RW Video
Remain 10h35m
Chase Play
Rec
Remain 0h52m
Stop
• The frame number is shown next to the
elapsed time display when the disc is
paused.
Recording time
• Copy Once or Can’t Record messages
may appear in the stop or recording
displays. These indicate that the
broadcast TV programme contains copy
control information.
Relative playback position
84
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing and recording from a DV camcorder
09
Chapter 9
Playing and recording from a
DV camcorder
You can play back and record video from a
DV camcorder connected to the DV IN jack
on the front panel of this recorder.
• The recorder will only start recording
from the DV IN jack if there is a valid
signal. Recording will pause if the signal
is interrupted during recording.
Important
• If your source is copy-protected using
Copy Guard, you will not be able to
record it. See Restrictions on video
recording on page 61 for more details.
• If you connect a second recorder using a
DV cable, you cannot control the second
unit from this one.
• You can’t control this unit remotely from
a component connected to the DV IN
jack.
Recording from a DV
camcorder
• The source signal must be DVC-SD
format.
Playing from a DV camcorder
• You can’t record date and time
information from DV cassette.
1
Make sure your DV camcorder is
connected to the front panel DV IN jack.
From the Initial Setup menu, check
• During DV recording, if a part of the tape
is blank, or has copy-protected material
on it, this recorder will pause recording.
Recording will restart automatically
when there is a recordable signal.
However, if there is more than two
minutes of blank tape, this recorder will
stop recording and the camcorder
should stop (depending on the
2
that the DV audio input is setup as you
would like.
See DV Input on page 133 for more on this.
• Check also that the Audio In settings for
External Audio and Bilingual
Recording are as you want them (see
Audio In on page 132).
camcorder).
HOME MENU
3
Select ‘DV’, then ‘DV Video
Playback’ from the Home Menu.
Copying from a DV source
Using the recorder’s remote, you can control
both the camcorder and this recorder.
4
Start playback on the camcorder.
Images from the camcorder should appear
on your TV.
• To record the incoming video, press
HDD/DVD to select the HDD or a DVD
for recording, then press ꢀ REC. Press
ꢀ STOP REC to finish recording.
If there is no signal from the device
connected to the DV jack, or the signal is
copy-protected, recording will pause. It
will automatically restart once there is a
recordable signal.
Important
• Some camcorders cannot be controlled
using this recorder’s remote.
• For best results when recording from a
DV camcorder to this recorder, we
recommend cueing the camcorder to
the place you want to start recording
from and setting the camcorder to
play-pause.
85
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing and recording from a DV camcorder
09
1
Make sure your DV camcorder is
• If you restart recording after stopping the
connected to the front panel DV IN jack.
Also, set the camcorder to VTR mode.
camcorder, the first few seconds of the
camcorder tape will not be recorded.
Use the pause button on your camcorder
instead and recording will start
immediately.
REC MODE
2
Set the recording quality.
• See Setting the picture quality/recording
time on page 64 for detailed information.
• HDD, DVD (VR Mode) and DVD-RAM only:
A chapter marker is inserted every time
there is a break in the timecode on the
DV tape. This happens when the
recording is stopped or paused then
restarted, for example.
3
From the Initial Setup menu, check
that the DV audio input is setup as you
would like.
See DV Input on page 133 for more on this.
• Check also that the Audio In settings for
External Audio and Bilingual
Recording are as you want them (see
Audio In on page 132).
• If you don’t want to see the DV recording
screen during recording, press DISPLAY
to hide it (press again to display).
• While recording, you cannot exit the DV
recording screen using the HOME
MENU or RETURN/EXIT button.
HOME MENU
4
Select ‘DV’, then ‘Copy from a
DV Source’ from the Home Menu.
• DV recording only works when the DV
camcorder is in VTR mode with a tape
loaded.
DV Auto Copy
DV Auto Copy allows you to make an exact
copy of the contents of a DV source to the
HDD or a DVD.
ENTER
5
Select ‘Record to Hard Disk
Drive’ or ‘Record to DVD’.
Find the place on the camcorder tape
1
Make sure your DV camcorder is
connected to the front panel DV IN jack.
6
that you want to start recording from.
For best results, pause playback at the point
from which you want to record.
Also, set the camcorder to VTR mode.
REC MODE
2
Set the recording quality.
• See Setting the picture quality/recording
time on page 64 for detailed information.
• Depending on your camcorder, you can
use this recorder’s remote to control the
camcorder using the ꢄ , ꢃ , ꢅ , ꢈ ,
ꢉ , ꢊ and ꢍ buttons.
3
From the Initial Setup menu, check
that the DV audio input is setup as you
require.
See DV Input on page 133 for more on this.
ENTER
7
Select ‘Start Rec’.
• Check also that the Audio In settings for
External Audio and Bilingual
Recording are as you want them (see
Audio In on page 132).
ꢄStop
1.02.22
ꢄStop
Control with these
Start Rec
Pause Rec
Stop Rec
buttons
HOME MENU
4
Select ‘DV’, then ‘DV Auto
ꢈ
ꢅ
ꢃ
ꢄ
ꢉ
ꢊ
ꢍ
Copy’ from the Home Menu.
• DV recording only works when the DV
camcorder is in VTR mode with a tape
loaded.
HDD
Rem.
SP (2h00m/DVD)
32h45m
• You can pause or stop the recording by
selecting Pause Rec or Stop Rec from
the on-screen display. You cannot
control the camcorder from this remote
control during recording.
86
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing and recording from a DV camcorder
09
• There’s a picture, but no sound!
ENTER
Try switching the DV Input setting (see
5
Select ‘Record to Hard Disk
DV Input on page 133) between Stereo 1
Drive’ or ‘Record to DVD’.
1
and Stereo 2.
The DV tape is rewound to the beginning.
Once it is rewound, the DV tape is played
from the beginning and copied to either the
HDD or a DVD.
About DV
Using DV, also known as i.LINK or IEEE 1394-
1995, you can connect a DV camcorder to
this recorder using a DV cable for input of
audio, video, data and control signals.
• If there is a gap of two minutes or more
between recorded contents, the copying
process is automatically stopped.
• Once copying is finished, the DV tape is
automatically rewound.
“i.LINK” and the “i.LINK” logo are
trademarks.
• To cancel the copying process, press
ꢀSTOP REC for more than three
seconds.
• This recorder is only compatible with DV-
format (DVC-SD) camcorders. Digital
satellite receivers and Digital VHS video
recorders are not compatible.
About automatic finalization
If you use a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or
DVD+R/+RW disc for copying, it will
automatically be finalized after copying is
complete.
• You cannot connect more than one DV
camcorder at a time to this recorder.
• You cannot control this recorder from
external equipment connected via the
DV IN jack.
• You can’t customize the background for
DVD-R/-RW or DVD+R/+RW disc
finalization.
• It may not always be possible to control
the connected camcorder via the DV IN
jack.
• No title names are assigned.
• DV camcorders can usually record audio
as stereo 16-bit/48 kHz, or twin stereo
tracks of 12-bit/32 kHz. This recorder can
only record one stereo audio track. Set
the DV Input setting as required (see DV
Input on page 133).
• If you want to give the disc a name,
please do so before you start the copy
(see Input Disc Name on page 121).
• If a timer recording is scheduled to start,
and in some other instances, the disc
will not be finalized.
• Audio input to the DV IN jack should be
32 kHz or 48 kHz (not 44.1 kHz).
Frequently Asked Questions
• Picture disturbance in the recording
may occur if the source component
pauses playback or plays an unrecorded
section of tape, or if the power fails in the
source component, or the DV cable is
disconnected.
• I can’t get my DV camcorder to work with
the recorder!
Check that the DV cable is properly
connected. Also make sure that what
you’re trying to record is not copy-
protected.
• The DV IN jack is an input only. There is
no output functionality.
If it still doesn’t work, try switching off
the camcorder then switch back on.
Note
1 If the audio subcode on the DV tape cannot be read correctly, the audio type will not switch automatically. You
can switch the audio manually from the External Audio setting (page 132).
87
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
CEhdapitetri1n0 g
Editing options
The table below shows which commands you can use with the HDD and different disc types.
DVD-R/-RW
(Video mode),
DVD+R/+RW
DVD-R/-RW, DVD-RAM
HDD
(VR mode)
Original
Play List
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Create (page 90)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Play (page 90)
Erase (page 90)
Edit > Title Name (page 91)
Edit > Set Thumbnail
(page 93)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Edit > Erase Section
(page 93)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Edit > Divide (page 94)
Edit > Chapter Edit
(page 94)
ꢀ
ꢀ
Edit > Set Genre (page 95)
Edit > Lock (page 96)
Edit > Move (page 96)
Edit > Combine (page 97)
Genre Name (page 97)
Multi-Mode (page 98)
Undo (page 99)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ *1
ꢀ *1
*1 DVD-R/-RW only
88
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
PREV
NEXT
The Disc Navigator screen
•
When in the title list, press to
display the previous/next page if there
are more titles than can be displayed.
The Disc Navigator screen is where you can
edit video content on unfinalized Video mode
and DVD-R/-RW (VR mode) discs, DVD+R/
+RW and DVD-RAM, as well as video
content on the hard disk drive.
DISPLAY
•
•
Press to change the title
information displayed in the title list.
HDD/DVD
Important
Press to switch between the HDD
and DVD Disc Navigator screens.
• Titles that have been recorded with a
Input Line System setting different to the
current setting of the recorder are shown
in the Disc Navigator with a blank
thumbnail image. See also Additional
information about the TV system settings
on page 141.
• If you are editing a DVD-R/-RW (VR
mode) or DVD-RAM disc you can display
the Play List by selecting Play List from
the view options panel (press ꢃ, then
select Play List from the view options,
then Play List).
• During recording, if you display the Disc
Navigator for the HDD, some of the titles
Disc Navigator (DVD)
10Titles
23:00 FRI 3/12
Style
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
SP
4
Titles
may appear with a
mark. These titles
2h00m(1.0G)
20:00 FRI 3/12
PlayList
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
SP
were recorded with a Input Line System
setting different to the current setting of
the recorder. During recording, these
titles cannot be played.
Original
MENU
2h00m(1.0G)
• Titles on the HDD marked with a
icon are recently recorded titles that
haven’t yet been played.
HDD/DVD
DISC
NAVIGATOR
1
2
Select the HDD or DVD.
3
Press to exit the Disc Navigator.
DISC
NAVIGATOR
Display the Disc Navigator
Editing accuracy
screen.
Some editing commands ask you whether
you want to keep Video mode compatibility
or frame accuracy (Video Mode Compatible
Editing or Frame Accurate Editing).
Playback will automatically stop when you
do this.
• The Disc Navigator is also accessible
from the Home Menu.
Frame Accurate Editing is very precise. The
edit point is accurate to the exact frame you
choose. However, this accuracy is not
preserved in any copy you make if you use
the high-speed copy function to make a
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW.
View options panel
Title list
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
4
SP
SP
h00m(1.0G)
Selected
title
2
4
Titles
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
SP
SP
Recent first
All Genres
MENU
2h00m(1.0G)
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
SP
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Video Mode Compatible Editing is less
precise. The edit point you choose will only
be accurate to within one-half to one second.
On the other hand, these edit points will be
preserved if you use high-speed copy to
make a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or
DVD+R/+RW.
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
30h30m
Available
recording time
Title thumbnail Title information Command
menu panel
•
Press to display the command
menu panel. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ and ENTER
buttons to navigate the menus.
89
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
HDD genres
Play
The large capacity of the HDD means that
there may be many hours of video in the
recorder. To help you organize your HDD
video content you can assign different
genres to titles. There are 20 genres in total,
including five user-definable ones that you
can name as you like.
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
Use this function to start playback of a title.
1
Highlight the title you want
to play.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
Create
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
Play List only
ENTER
Use this function to create a Play List and
add titles to it.
2
Select ‘Play’ from the
command menu panel.
Playback of the title you selected starts.
Before you can use this command, make
sure that the Play List is switched on in the
view options panel on the left.
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP
4
Play
SP
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
Erase
2
4
Titles
ENTER
Edit
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
S
S
1
Select ‘Create’ from the
Recent first
All Genres
Genre Name
S
S
command menu panel.
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
M
u
lti-Mode
Disc Navigator (DVD)
0Titles
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
Play
1h00m(1.0G)
No title
Remain
30h30m
Erase
2
Edit
4
Titles
Play List
Create
Erase
Undo
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
DVD
VR Mode
Remain
Use this function to erase unwanted titles.
0h30m
When you erase titles from the HDD or
Original titles from a VR mode DVD-RW, the
available recording space increases
ENTER
2
Select an original title to add
accordingly. Erasing a title from a DVD-RW
(Video mode) or DVD+RW disc increases
the available recording time only if it is the
to the Play List.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
1
last title on the disc.
Repeat these two steps to add as many titles
as necessary to the Play List.
Erasing Play List titles, or titles from a
DVD-R (VR mode or Video mode) or DVD+R,
will not result in any more free space on the
disc.
Note
90
En
1 There may be cases where erasing a title from a DVD+R/+RW disc will result in incontiguous title numbers.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
ENTER
1
Highlight the title you want
3
Input a name for the selected
to erase.
title.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
Input Title Name
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP
A B C D E
F
G H
I
J
K L M
.
(
I
,
)
I
ß
_
}
˚
`
?
:
!
;
CAPS
small
N
A
D
0
O
A
N
1
P
A
O
2
Q
A
O
3
R
A
O
4
S T U V WX Y Z
ç
ENTER
A
O
5
[
§
·
Æ
O
6
E
U
8
ˆ
E
U
9
÷
<<
E
U
<
x
E
U
=
I
I
#
%
ø
7
]
Y
>
{
$
2
Select ‘Erase’ from the
&
~
+
–
/
@
¥
|
¡
_
a
–
command menu panel.
c
£
\
µ
¨
¸
©
¬
–
/2
®
/4
< < 14
/
o
–
1
3
2
3
1
¿
¶
´
OK
Clear
Space
ENTER
3
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’
to cancel.
• A name generated automatically by the
recorder will already be in the name
input section of the screen. Use the
ꢈ/ꢉ buttons to change the cursor
position.
Tip
• You can erase a title quickly by pressing
CLEAR when the title is highlighted.
Confirm the edit by pressing ENTER.
• Select CAPS or small to change to upper
or lower-case, or use the
CASE SELECTION buttons (ꢆ PREV/
ꢇ NEXT).
Title Name
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD
• You can also use the CLEAR button to
delete characters directly (press and
hold for two seconds to delete the whole
name). For other remote control key
shortcuts, see Using the remote key
shortcuts to input a name on page 92.
You can give titles new names of up to 64
characters long for VR mode, DVD-RAM and
HDD recordings, and up to 40 characters for
Video mode recordings and DVD+R/+RW
discs.
• For discs formatted on a different DVD
recorder, you will see only a limited
character set.
1
Highlight the title you want
to name (or rename).
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
ENTER
4
Select ‘OK’ to enter the name
and return to the main Disc Navigator
screen.
• To return to the main Disc Navigator
screen without saving changes to the
title name, press RETURN/EXIT.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Title Name’
from the command menu panel.
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP
4
Title Name
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
Set Thumbnail
4
Titles
Erase Section
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Divide
Chapter Edit
Recent first
All Genres
Set Genre
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
Lock
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
30h30m
91
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
Using the remote key shortcuts to
input a name
The table below shows the remote control
key shortcuts that you can use to input
characters in the name input screen.
Pressing a button repeatedly cycles through
the characters shown.
Using a USB keyboard to enter a name
Using a USB keyboard connected to this
recorder makes entering names very quick
1
and convenient. When in USB keyboard
input mode, a USB icon ( ) appears in the
2
lower-left of the screen.
Other than the standard alpha-numeric
keys, use the following keys when entering
If you want to enter two characters in
succession that are both on the same button
(for example a P and an R), press ꢉ to
advance the cursor one space manually
between inputting the two characters.
names:
Key
Function
Change the cursor position
Key
1
Characters
Key
6
Characters
ꢃ ꢀ
. , ’ ? ! – & 1
m n o 6 ö ô ò ó
ø ñ
Select CAPS
F1
a b c 2 ä à á â ã
æ ç
p q r s 7 $
2
7
Select small
*1
F2
ÿ/ß
d e f 3 è é ë ê
g h i 4 î ï ì í ¡
j k l 5 £
t u v 8 ü ù û ú
3
4
8
9
Delete character at the current
cursor position
delete
w x y z 9
0
Delete the character at the
previous cursor position
back
5
0
space
ꢈ
[cursor back]
ꢉ
[cursor for-
ward]
Enter the name
enter
ꢆ/ [change case] CLEAR [clear charac-
Exit the input screen
esc
ꢇ
ter]
ꢅ
<space>
ꢄ
[finish name
input]
~
+
( ) _ / : ; ” ` ^ @ # ∗ % ¥ | + =
{ } [ ] < >
*1
lower-case: ÿ; upper-case: ß
Note
1 • It’s possible that some USB keyboards will not work exactly as expected when connected to this recorder. See
also Connecting a USB device on page 22 for more connection information.
• Certain keyboards may not be able to correctly input all characters.
2 If you use the remote control to enter a name when in the USB keyboard input mode, the recorder will
automatically switch to remote control input mode. Press any key on the USB keyboard to return to USB
keyboard input mode.
92
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
Set Thumbnail
Erase Section
HDD DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM
HDD DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
You can change the thumbnail picture that
appears in the Disc Navigator for a title to
any frame that appears in that title.
Using this command you can delete a part of
a title, ideal for cutting out the commercial
breaks in a recording made from the TV.
1
Highlight the title you want
1
Highlight the title containing
to change the thumbnail picture for.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
the section you want to erase.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
ENTER
ENTER
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Set Thumbnail’
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Erase Section’
from the command menu panel.
The thumbnail setting screen appears from
from the command menu panel.
which you can find the frame you want.
ENTER
3
edit.
HDD only: Select the type of
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP
4
4
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Title Name
HDD/DVD RECORDER
Set Thumbnail
!
4
Titles
Erase Section
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
Divide
Chapter Edit
Please select the type of editing.
Video Mode Compatible Editing is
recommended for compatibility with
high-speed copying.
Recent first
All Genres
Set Genre
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
Lock
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
Remain
30h30m
Video Mode Compatible Editing
Frame Accurate Editing
1h00m(1.0G)
3
Use the playback controls (ꢃ, ꢅ, ꢈ,
• For more information about these
options, see Editing accuracy on page 89.
ꢉ, etc.) to find a suitable frame, then
press ENTER to set.
4
Highlight ‘From’ then use the
Set Thumbnail (HDD)
playback controls (ꢃ, ꢅ, ꢈ, ꢉ, etc.) to
find the start of the section to erase, then
press ENTER.
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP
2h00m
Rec. time
The bar at the bottom of the screen indicates
the current play position in the title. After
pressing ENTER, a marker shows the start of
the section.
10-1 00.00.09.15
Play Pause
ꢅ
OK
Exit
You can also use the chapter and time
search features (press the YELLOW button),
and the Smart Jog (for CM SKIP and CM
BACK).
Erase Section (HDD)
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP
2h00m
Rec. time
10-1 00.00.09.15
ꢅ
Play Pause
From
4
Select ‘Exit’ to return to the
To
Exit
Edit screen.
93
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
4
Use the playback controls (ꢃ, ꢅ, ꢈ,
ENTER
ꢉ, etc.) to find the place you want to
divide the title.
5
Highlight ‘To’ then, in the
same way, find the end of the section to
erase, then press ENTER.
Divide Title (HDD)
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP
After pressing ENTER, another marker
indicates the end of the section, with the
section itself marked in red.
2h00m
Rec. time
10–1 00.00.09.15
ꢅ
Play Pause
ENTER
Divide
Cancel
6
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’
to cancel.
In the thumbnail viewer you can see a few
seconds of video either side of the marked
section to see how the edit will look.
ENTER
5
Press to divide the title at the
current playback position.
• When editing VR mode Original content,
you may not be able to erase very short
sections (less than five seconds).
ENTER
6
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’
to cancel.
Divided titles cannot
be combined.
OK?
!
Divide
Yes
No
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
HDD
Play List only
Use this command to divide a title into two.
Note that once divided, the two new HDD
titles cannot be recombined into one again.
Chapter Edit
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM HDD
When editing a VR mode DVD or video on
the HDD you can edit individual chapters
within a title, with commands for erasing,
combining and dividing.
1
Highlight the title you want
to divide.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
1
Highlight the title that contains the
chapters you want to edit.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Divide’ from
the command menu panel.
3
HDD only: Select the type of edit.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Chapter Edit’
HDD/DVD RECORDER
!
from the command menu panel.
Please select the type of editing.
Video Mode Compatible Editing is
recommended for compatibility with
high-speed copying.
Video Mode Compatible Editing
Frame Accurate Editing
• For more information about these
options, see Editing accuracy on page 89.
94
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
Move command only: Select the
destination for the chapter, and press
ENTER.
ENTER
3
edit.
HDD only: Select the type of
Chapter Edit (DVD VR mode Play List)
19:00 Mon 29/11 P
HDD/DVD RECORDER
Erase
!
Rec. time
Chapter
1
Move
0
Cancel
Please select the type of editing.
Video Mode Compatible Editing is
recommended for compatibility with
high-speed copying.
001
002
003
004
005
Exit
Divide
Erase/Move
Combine
3
Video Mode Compatible Editing
Frame Accurate Editing
• Combine – Combine two adjacent
chapters into one: Highlight the bar
divider between two adjacent chapters
and press ENTER.
• For more information about these
options, see Editing accuracy on page 89.
Chapter Edit (DVD VR mode Play List)
4
Select the command you want:
• Divide – Divide a chapter into two or
more parts: Use the playback controls
(ꢃ, ꢅ, ꢈ, ꢉ, etc.) to find the point at
which you want to divide the chapter,
then press ENTER.
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
SP
Rec. time
1h00m
1
2
3
4
5
Exit
Divide
Erase/Move
Combine
Chapter Edit (DVD VR mode Play List)
ENTER
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
SP
Rec. time
Chapters
1h00m
5
5
Select ‘Exit’ to get back to the
main Disc Navigator screen.
1–1
Play
0.00.00
ꢃ
Exit
Divide
Erase/Move
Combine
Set Genre
HDD
You can keep dividing the chapter as
many times as you wish (up to 999
chapters per DVD-R/-RW/-RAM disc or
99 chapters per HDD title).
Use this command to assign a genre to a
title.
1
2
• Erase /Move – Erase or move
chapters: Select the chapter you want to
erase/move and press ENTER. Select
whether you want to erase or move the
chapter.
1
Highlight the title you want
to assign a genre to.
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
Note
1 When editing VR mode Original content, it may not be possible to erase chapters less than five seconds long.
2 VR mode Play List only.
3 It may not always be possible to combine two chapters, even though they are adjacent. If a chapter has been
divided into three, then the middle chapter erased, it is not possible to combine the two remaining chapters into
one.
95
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
ENTER
ENTER
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Set Genre’ from
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Lock’ from the
the command menu panel.
command menu panel.
Disc Navigator (HDD)
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10
10Titles
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
4
SP
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP
4
4
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Title Name
Title Name
Set Thumbnail
Set Thumbnail
4
Titles
4
Titles
Erase Section
Erase Section
9
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
Divide
Divide
Chapter Edit
Chapter Edit
Recent first
All Genres
Recent first
All Genres
Set Genre
Set Genre
8
7
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
Lock
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
Lock
Cancel
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
Remain
30h30m
HDD
SP
Remain
30h30m
1h00m(1.0G)
1h00m(1.0G)
An unlocked title will become locked; a
locked title will be unlocked. Locked titles
are shown in the Disc Navigator with a
padlock icon.
ENTER
3
Select a genre for the title.
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10
10Titles
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP
4
Move
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
No Category
Movies
4
Titles
9
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Drama
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
Play List only
Entertainmt.
Recent first
All Genres
News
Sport
8
7
22:00 THU 2/12 P
22:00 Thu 2/12 P
Use this function to re-arrange the playing
order of Play List titles.
Comedy
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
Remain
30h30m
1h00m(1.0G)
1
Highlight the title you want
to move.
Lock
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
HDD DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM
Original only
ENTER
You can lock a title so that it can’t be edited
or erased accidently. If you do need to edit it,
you can always unlock it later.
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Move’ from the
command menu panel.
Disc Navigator (DVD)
10Titles
Important
1
2
3
4
23:00 FRI 3/12
23:00Fri 3/12Pr
Title Name
Se
EraseSection
Divide
t
T
humbnail
4
Titles
• You can’t undo any edits made before
changing the lock status. You also can’t
undo a lock/unlock command using the
Undo option from the Disc Navigator
menu.
20:00 FRI 3/12
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Chapter Edit
Play List
Move
Combine
22:00 THU 2/12
22:00 Thu 2/12 P
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
DVD
VR Mode
2
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
1
Highlight the title you want to lock
0h30m
(or unlock).
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
96
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
ENTER
ENTER
3
Select a new position for the
3
Select another title to
title.
combine with the first.
This title will be appended to the first title
selected.
Title to move
Disc Navigator (DVD)
10Titles
The screen below shows title 3 selected to be
appended to title 1.
1
23:00 FRI 3/12
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
SP
2h00m(1.0G)
4
Titles
2
3
4
20:00 FRI 3/12
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Disc Navigator (DVD)
10Titles
9
SP
Play List
MENU
2h00m(1.0G)
1
23:00 FRI 3/12
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
22:00 THU 2/12
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
4
SP
7
SP
2h00m(1.0G)
4
Titles
1h00m(1.0G)
2
20:00 FRI 3/12
19:00 MON 29/11
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
SP
2h00m(1.0G)
DVD
VR Mode
Remain
0h30m
2
SP
Play List
MENU
1h00m(1.0G)
3
22:00 THU 2/12
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Insert position
4
19:00 MON 29/11
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
DVD
2
SP
VR Mode
After pressing ENTER, the new, updated Play
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
0h30m
List is displayed.
ENTER
Combine
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
Play List only
to cancel.
Use this function to combine two Play List
titles into one.
OK to combine titles
1 and 3 ?
!
Yes
No
1
Highlight the title you want
Genre Name
to combine.
HDD
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
titles.
Use this command to rename one of the five
user-definable genres (Free 1 to Free 5).
This title will remain in the same place after
combining with another title.
ENTER
ENTER
1
Select ‘Genre Name’ from the
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Combine’ from
command menu panel.
the command menu panel.
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
Disc Navigator (DVD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Erase
4
4
SP
SP
Play
1
23:00 FRI 3/12
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Title Name
2
Edit
4
Titles
Set
T
h
u
m
b
ail
n
4
Titles
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
S
S
EraseSection
Divide
Chapter Edit
2
3
4
20:00 FRI 3/12
Recent first
All Genres
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Genre Name
S
S
Play List
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
Move
Combine
22:00 THU 2/12
22:00 Thu 2/12 P
Multi-Mode
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2 SP
2
HDD
SP
SP
19:00 MON 29/11
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
DVD
VR Mode
2
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
30h30m
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
0h30m
97
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
Multi-Mode
ENTER
HDD
2
Select one of the user-
definable genre names.
Multi-Mode allows you to select several
titles, then select a command that will be
applied to all of them. In this way you can
select multiple titles and then erase them all
at once, for example.
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
4
4
SP
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
Free1
Free2
Free3
4
Titles
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
Free4
Free5
Recent first
All Genres
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
C
a
ncel
ENTER
1
Select ‘Multi-Mode’ from the
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2 SP
2
HDD
SP
SP
command menu panel.
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
30h30m
Disc Navigator (HDD)
10Titles
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP
Play
4
4
ENTER
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
SP
Erase
3
Input a name for the genre.
2
Edit
4
Titles
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
S
S
• The name can be up to 12 characters
long.
Recent first
All Genres
Genre Name
S
S
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
• For information on remote control key
short cuts, see Using the remote key
shortcuts to input a name on page 92.
Multi-Mode
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2 SP
HDD
SP
2
SP
1h00m(1.0G)
Remain
30h30m
Input Genre Name
Free
1
ENTER
A B C D E
F
G H
I
J
K L M
.
(
I
,
)
I
ß
_
}
˚
`
?
:
!
;
CAPS
small
2
Select titles from the title list.
N
A
D
0
O
A
N
1
P
A
O
2
Q
A
O
3
R
A
O
4
S T U V WX Y Z
ç
A
O
5
[
§
·
Æ
O
6
E
U
8
ˆ
E
U
9
÷
<<
E
U
<
x
E
U
=
I
I
#
%
ø
7
]
Y
>
{
$
Selected titles are marked with a ꢅ.
&
~
+
–
/
@
¥
|
¡
_
a
–
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select
c
£
\
µ
¨
¸
©
¬
–
/2
®
/4
< < 14
/
o
–
1
3
2
3
1
¿
¶
´
titles.
Space
OK
Clear
ENTER
3
Select the command that you
ENTER
want applied to all the marked titles.
For example, select Erase to erase all the
marked titles.
4
and exit.
Select ‘OK’ to enter the name
Disc Navigator (HDD)
Multi-Mode
10Titles
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
4
4
SP
SP
Erase
Lock
2
4
Titles
Unlock
9
Change Genre
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr
9
9
S
S
Recent first
All Genres
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr
7
7
SSingle Mode
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr
2
2
SP
SP
HDD
SP
Remain
30h30m
1h00m(1.0G)
Once the command is completed, Multi-
Mode is automatically exited.
98
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing
10
Undo
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW
If you make a mistake while editing, you can
generally undo it. There is one level of undo
(in other words, you can only undo the last
edit you made).
ENTER
•
Select ‘Undo’ from the
command menu panel.
• You can’t undo anything after exiting the
Disc Navigator screen.
Disc Navigator (DVD)
0Titles
No title
Play
Erase
2
4
Titles
Edit
Play List
Create
Undo
DVD
VR Mode
Remain
0h30m
Frequently asked questions
• Why doesn’t the available recording time
increase when I erase titles from a VR
mode DVD-R?
When you erase titles from a DVD-R (or
DVD+R), the titles are no longer
displayed, but the content remains on
the disc. DVD-R/+R are write-once
media; they can’t be erased or rewritten.
• I can’t edit my disc!
You may find that as the available
recording time is reduced on a VR mode
DVD-R disc, editing is no longer
possible. This is because information
about your edits requires a certain
amount of disc space. As you edit, this
information builds up, eventually
preventing you from editing further.
99
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
CChaoptpery11ing and backup
Restrictions on copying
Introduction
Commercial DVD-Video discs are protected
using Copy Guard. These discs cannot be
copied to the HDD.
Use the copying features of this recorder to:
• Back up important recordings stored on
the HDD to a DVD.
Some video material is copy-once protected.
This means that it can be recorded to HDD,
but it can’t then be freely copied again. If you
want to transfer copy-once protected
material from HDD to DVD, you’ll need to a
CPRM ver. 1.1 or higher VR mode DVD-RW,
ver. 2.0 or 2.1 VR mode DVD-R, or CPRM-
compatible DVD-RAM disc (see CPRM on
page 61 for more on this). Only one instance
of a copy-once protected title can be added
to the Copy List, and after it’s been copied,
the title is erased from the HDD (it is
• Make a DVD copy of a recording on the
HDD to play in another player.
• Transfer video from a DVD to the HDD
for editing.
• Transfer edited video from the HDD to
DVD.
The simplest way to copy a title is to use the
One Touch Copy feature. This copies the
currently playing HDD title to DVD, or DVD
title to the HDD. See One Touch Copy below
for detailed instructions.
therefore not possible to copy a locked title
that is copy-once protected).
For more sophisticated copying tasks you
can build a Copy List of titles to copy, and
edit titles so that you only copy the bits you
want. See Using Copy Lists on page 102 for
detailed instructions.
You can identify copy-once protected
material during playback by displaying disc
information on-screen. If the current title is
copy-once protected, an exclamation mark
( ! ) is shown.
Where possible, the recorder will copy your
recordings at high-speed. Depending on the
recording mode, the kind of disc loaded and
various other factors, copying can be as fast
as one minute per hour of video. See
Minimum copying times on page 144 for
more on copying times.
Copyright
Recording equipment should be used only
for lawful copying and you are advised to
check carefully what is lawful copying in the
country in which you are making a copy.
Copying of copyright material such as films
or music is unlawful unless permitted by a
legal exception or consented to by the
rightowners.
If you want to save disc space you can copy
video at a lower recording quality (for
example, an XP recording on the HDD
copied to SP on a DVD). Copying in this way
is always done in real-time.
When real-time copying from the HDD to a
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW,
the chapter markers in the original material
are not copied. Chapter markers are put into
the copy at intervals, according to the Auto
Chapter settings (see also Auto Chapter
(Video) and Auto Chapter (DVD+R/+RW) on
page 136).
One Touch Copy
* See also Copyright above.
The One Touch Copy feature copies the
currently playing or selected (in the Disc
Navigator) HDD title to DVD, or DVD title to
HDD. The whole title is copied, regardless of
where in the title you start the copy.
100
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
HDD to DVD copies are made in the same
recording mode. When copying DVD to
HDD, the copy is made in whatever
recording mode is currently set.
characters of a name are copied.
• The chapter markers in the copy may not
be in exactly the same positions as the
original when recording on to a DVD-R/
-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW.
Make sure that a recordable DVD disc is
loaded when trying to copy from the HDD.
• You can’t use the One Touch Copy
function to copy a title if any part of the
title is copy-once protected.
REC MODE
1
If you’re copying from DVD to the
HDD, select a recording mode.
Note that selecting a recording mode higher
than the title playing will not result in a better
quality recording.
• A title that contains mixed aspect ratios
can’t be copied to a DVD-R/-RW (Video
mode) or DVD+R/+RW. Use a DVD-R/
-RW (VR mode) or DVD-RAM disc for
this type of material.
ONE TOUCH
COPY
1
2
Press during playback to copy
• Low resolution (SEP through LP modes )
the current title.
The front panel display indicates that the title
is being copied.
widescreen material can’t be copied to a
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/
+RW. Use a DVD-R/-RW (VR mode) or
DVD-RAM disc for this type of material.
• High-speed copying is used when
copying from the HDD to DVD. Playback
continues while copying.
• When HDD Recording Format is set to
Video Mode Off, titles recorded in LP/
MN9 to MN15 modes cannot be high-
speed copied to a DVD-R/
-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW.
Please use a DVD-R/-RW (VR mode) or
DVD-RAM.
• Real-time copying is used when copying
from DVD to the HDD. Playback restarts
from the beginning of the title.
Cancelling One Touch Copy
You can cancel a One Touch Copy once it’s
started.
• Recordings of bilingual broadcasts
cannot be high-speed copied to a
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/
+RW. Please use a DVD-R/-RW (VR
mode) or DVD-RAM.
ONE TOUCH
COPY
•
Press and hold for more than a
second.
• XP+ titles cannot be copied to DVD via
One Touch Copy.
Copying is cancelled and the video already
copied is erased.
• Titles over eight hours cannot be copied
to single-layer DVD+R/+RW discs using
One Touch Copy. Use DVD+R DL discs
for titles over eight hours.
• If you cancel a HDD to DVD-R/+R copy,
the space available for recording does
not return to the pre-copy figure.
• Titles recorded in MN1 to MN6, SEP, SLP
or EP mode cannot be copied to DVD+R/
+RW using One Touch Copy.
Notes on copying using One Touch
Copy
Copying to DVD
Copying to the HDD
• Title name, chapter markers, as well as
thumbnail picture markers for the Disc
Navigator, are also copied. However, if
you copy to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)
or DVD+R/+RW, only the first 40
• The maximum title length for copying is
12 hours.
• Title name and chapter markers are also
copied, except when copying from a
finalized Video mode DVD-R/-RW.
Note
101
En
1 In manual recording mode these equate to MN1 to MN15 (Video Mode Off) or MN1 to MN8 (Video Mode On).
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
• Thumbnail picture markers and chapter
markers for the Disc Navigator are
copied, but their position in the copy
may be slightly changed from the
original.
HOME MENU
2
Select ‘Copy’ from the Home
Menu.
ENTER
3
Select ‘HDD ꢄ DVD’.
• If some part of the title being copied is
copy-protected, copying will start, but
the copy-protected portions will not be
copied.
HDD
DVD
HDD
DVD/CD
Disc Back-up
• If this is the first time to create a Copy
List, skip to step 5 below.
Using Copy Lists
4
If there is already a Copy List stored
* See also Copyright on page 100.
in the recorder, choose whether to
‘Create New Copy List’ or ‘Continue
Using Previous Copy List’.
At its simplest, a Copy List is just a list of
HDD or DVD titles that you want to copy.
When copying HDD titles to DVD, you can,
however, edit the titles in your copy list,
erasing chapters you don’t need, or re-
naming titles, for example. Edits you make to
titles in the Copy List do not affect the actual
video content; only the ‘virtual’ content of the
Copy List. So you can freely erase and modify
anything in your Copy List safe in the
knowledge that the actual content is not
being altered.
Continue Using Previous Copy List
Create New Copy List
• If you select Continue Using Previous
Copy List, skip to step 10 below.
• Selecting Create New Copy List will
erase any Copy List already stored in the
recorder.
Copying from HDD to DVD
ENTER
Important
5
Add titles to the Copy List
• The recorder can only store one Copy List
at a time.
(highlight a title and press ENTER to add).
8
Title
Copy
Select Title
HDD DVD (Video mode)
1 > 2 > 3
• The Copy List is erased if the Input Line
System setting is changed (see
Additional information about the TV
system settings on page 141).
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
WED 29/03 20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
MON 27/03 21:00 Mon27/03 Pr 4 SP
S AT 25/03 23:00 S a t 25/03 Pr 9 SP
THU 23/03 22:00 Thu 23/03 Pr 6 SP
WED 22/03 20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2 SP
MON 20/03 13:00 Mon20/03 Pr 9 SP
F R I 17/03 21:00 F r i 17/03 Pr 4 SP
WED 15/03 20:00 Wed15/03 Pr 2 SP
Pr 2
Pr 4
Pr 9
Pr 6
Pr 2
Pr 9
Pr 4
Pr 2
Back
Next
Recent first
All Genres
• Resetting the recorder to its factory
settings (see Resetting the recorder on
page 157) will erase the Copy List.
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
20:00
1h00m(2.0G)
Pr 2
Sports
SP
Copy List Total
Current DVD Remain
0.0G
4.3G
1
Load a recordable DVD.
• It is possible to complete the following
steps without having a recordable DVD
loaded (or having an uninitialized DVD
loaded); however, the steps are slightly
different.
Titles you’ve added to the Copy List are
highlighted in pink.
There are some restrictions on titles that can
be added to the Copy List if you are copying
to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/
+RW:
• If you want to use a DVD-RW (VR mode)
disc for the copy, make sure it is
initialized before you start.
102
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
• When adding titles that contain copy-
once protected material, the copy-once
parts will not be added.
8
To edit a title, highlight it using the
ꢁ/ꢂ buttons, then press ENTER.
2
Title
Copy
Title Edit
HDD DVD (Video mode)
1 > 2 > 3
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2
• When adding titles that contain material
of more than one aspect ratio (screen
size), each part with a different aspect
ratio will be added as a separate title if
high-speed copying is possible.
1
2
Erase
20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2
Title Name
Back
Next
Erase Section
Move
Preview
Cancel
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
1
Depending on the title , high-speed copying
1h00m(2.0G)
may not be possible to DVDs.
Copy List Total
4.3G
4.3G
Current DVD Remain
6
Press ꢀ to display the command
menu panel.
A menu of editing commands appears:
• Erase – Erase individual titles from the
The Command Menu panel
Copy List (see Erase on page 90).
8
Title
Copy
Select Title
HDD
DVD (Video mode)
• Title Name – Name or rename a title in
the Copy List (see Title Name on
page 91).
1
>
2
>
3
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
WED 29/03 20:00 Wed29/03 Pr
MON 27/03 21:00 Mon27/03 Pr
S A T 25/03 23:00 S a t 25/03 Pr
THU 23/03 22:00 Thu 23/03 Pr
WED 22/03 20:00 Wed22/03 Pr
MON 20/03 13:00 Mon20/03 Pr
F R I 17/03 21:00 F r i 17/03 Pr
WED 15/03 20:00 Wed15/03 Pr
2
4
9
6
2
9
4
2
SP
SP
SP
SP
SP
SP
SP
SP
Pr
Pr
Pr
Pr
Pr
Pr
Pr
Pr
2
4
9
6
2
9
4
2
Back
Next
Recent first
All Genres
• Erase Section – Erase part of a title (see
Erase Section on page 93).
20:00
20:00
Wed29/03
Pr
1h00m(2.0G)
Sports SP
2
SP
• Move – Change the order of titles in the
Pr
2
Copy List (see Move on page 96).
Copy List Total
Current DVD Remain
4.3G
4.3G
• Preview – Check the content of a title in
the Copy List.
7
Select ‘Next’ to move on to the Title
Edit screen.
• Divide – Divide a title in the Copy List
into two (see Divide on page 94).
2
Title
Copy
HDD DVD (Video mode)
1 > 2 > 3
Title Edit
• Combine – Combine two titles in the
Copy List into one (see Combine on
page 97).
1
2
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2 SP
Back
Next
• Chapter Edit – Edit chapters within a
Copy List title (see Chapter Edit on
page 94):
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
1h00m(2.0G)
• Divide – Divide a chapter into two.
• Erase/Move – Erase a chapter/
Change the chapter order.
• Combine – Combine two chapters
into one.
Copy List Total
Current DVD Remain
4.3G
4.3G
Note
1 The following titles cannot be copied at high-speed for DVD+R/+RW:
• Titles recorded in MN1 to MN6, SEP, SLP or EP mode.
The following titles cannot be copied at high-speed for DVD-R/-RW (Video Mode) and DVD+R/+RW:
• Widescreen titles recorded at low resolution (SEP through LP/MN1 to MN15 (Video Mode Off) or MN1 to MN8
(Video Mode On)).
• LP/MN9 to MN15 recordings when HDD Recording Format is set to Video Mode Off.
• Bilingual recordings.
• Combined titles that were originally recorded using different recording modes.
The following titles cannot be copied at high-speed for any types of DVD:
• XP+ titles.
103
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
• Set Thumbnail – Set the thumbnail
frame for a title (see Set Thumbnail on
page 93).
• Select Finalize if you want to
automatically finalize a DVD-R/-RW
(Video mode) or DVD+R after copying.
Select a title menu style from the
following screen.
1
• Recording Mode – Set the picture
quality of the copy (see Recording Mode
on page 105).
ENTER
• Bilingual – Set how bilingual audio
should be copied when copying from
HDD to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) and
DVD+R/+RW (see Bilingual on
page 106).
11
Select ‘Start Copy’ to start
copying.
Copy
HDD DVD (Video Mode)
1 > 2 > 3
Start Copy
HDD
DVD-RW
Video Mode
• Cancel – Exit the menu.
Back
Recording Mode
Input Disc Name
Finalize
Copy Time 0h 16m
Repeat this step for as many titles you have
that need editing.
Recording Mode
Disc Name
High-Speed
Off
Finalize
Start Copy
Copy List Total
Current DVD Remain
4.3G
4.3G
9
Display the command menu
Select ‘Next’ to proceed.
• If you’re using a DVD-R DL or DVD+R DL
disc and the copy will span both layers,
the Copy List Total bar will be purple.
panel.
ENTER
• The Current DVD Remain bar will be
half-length if the first layer of a DVD-R DL
or DVD+R DL disc is already full.
10
2
Title
Copy
Title Edit
HDD DVD (Video mode)
1 > 2 > 3
1
2
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2 SP
Copying from DVD to HDD
Back
Next
Important
• The DVD to HDD Copy screen isn’t
accessible when a finalized Video mode
DVD-R/-RW or a DVD-Video is loaded. As
long as the disc is not Copy Guard
protected, you can still use the One
Touch Copy function, however (See One
Touch Copy on page 100).
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP
1h00m(2.0G)
Copy List Total
4.3G
4.3G
Current DVD Remain
There are several options available from the
next screen:
• Select Recording Mode if you want to
change the recording quality (see
Recording Mode on page 105).
• The recorder can only store one Copy List
at a time.
• Select Input Disc Name if you want to
change the disc name. Input a name of
up to 64 characters for a VR mode disc or
40 characters for a Video mode disc or
DVD+R/+RW. (The input method is
similar to that of naming titles; see Title
Name on page 91.)
• The Copy List will be erased if:
– any of the titles on the DVD disc are
erased or edited.
– the disc tray is opened.
– playback is switched between Play List
and Original.
– the DVD disc is re-initialized or
finalized.
Note
104
En
1 If a timer recording is scheduled to start during copying, the disc will not be finalized.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
– the recorder is reset to its factory
settings (see Resetting the recorder on
page 157).
Repeat this step for as many titles you have
that need editing.
ENTER
• It may not be possible to copy from a
DVD disc that was recorded on a
different DVD recorder or a PC.
7
Select ‘Next’ from the
command menu panel to proceed to the
copy options screen.
• Select Recording Mode if you want to
change the recording quality (see
Recording Mode below).
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Copy’ from the Home
Menu.
ENTER
2
3
Select ‘DVD/CD ꢄ HDD’.
ENTER
8
Select ‘Start Copy’ to start
ENTER
copying.
Select a Copy List type.
• Selecting Create New Copy List will
erase any Copy List already stored in the
recorder.
Recording Mode
ENTER
1
Select ‘Recording Mode’ from
ENTER
the command menu panel.
4
Add titles to the Copy List
(highlight a title and press ENTER to add).
Titles you’ve added to the Copy List are
highlighted in pink.
ENTER
2
Select a recording mode for
the copy.
1
• High-Speed Copy – The Copy List is
copied at the same recording quality as
the original.
ENTER
5
Select ‘Next’ from the
command menu panel to proceed to the
title edit screen.
2
• XP, SP, LP, EP, SLP, SEP, MN – The Copy
List is copied at the specified recording
quality in real-time. (Note that if you copy
at a higher quality setting than the
original, the copy will not be better
quality than the original.)
ENTER
6
Select a title to edit.
A menu appears of Copy List editing
commands:
• Erase – Erase individual titles from the
Copy List (see Erase on page 90).
If you select MN above, you can also
change the level setting (MN1 to
3
4
• Move – Change the order of titles in the
Copy List (see Move on page 96).
MN32 , LPCM or XP+ ) from the
Recording Quality box that appears.
• Preview – Check the content of a title in
the Copy List.
• Cancel – Exit the menu.
Note
1 When copying to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW, the chapter markers in the copy may not be in
exactly the same position as the original.
2 When the copy mode is set to something other than High-Speed Copy for copying to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)
or DVD+R/+RW, the chapter markers of the original are not copied. Chapter markers are put into the copy at
regular intervals, according to the Auto Chapter setting (see also Auto Chapter (Video) and Auto Chapter
(DVD+R/+RW) on page 136).
3 When copying to a DVD+R/+RW, MN1 to MN3 and SEP modes are not available.
4 XP+ mode available only when copying to HDD.
105
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
1,2
• Optimized – The recording quality is
ENTER
automatically adjusted so that the Copy
List fits on to the space available on the
disc. Copying is carried out in real-time.
2
Select a backup option.
Start new disc back-up
Resume writing data
Erase back-up data
When you change the recording mode
setting, you can see how much disc space it
will require. If this is more than is available,
it shows up in red and you won’t be able to
start copying. In this case, either change the
recording quality, or press RETURN/EXIT to
go back to the Copy List screen and erase
one or more titles from the Copy List.
There are three backup options:
• Start new disc back-up – Start making
a backup of a disc.
• Resume writing data – Record the
backup data already on the HDD to a
recordable DVD.
Bilingual
• Erase back-up data – Erase the backup
data on the HDD.
1
Select the title containing the
audio you want to change.
3
Load the disc you want to make a
backup of.
You can only make backup copies of
finalized Video mode DVD-R/-RW discs,
finalized DVD+R or DVD+RW discs
(excluding DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL discs).
ENTER
2
Select ‘Bilingual’ from the
command menu panel.
ENTER
Disc Back-up
3
Select a bilingual audio
No disc.
option.
Please load a disc to be backed-up.
Cancel
Start
Using disc backup
* See also Copyright on page 100.
ENTER
This feature offers a simple way to make a
backup copy of finalized DVD-R/-RW (Video
mode) discs or DVD+R/+RW discs. The
data is copied first to the hard disk drive ,
then on to another recordable DVD disc.
4
Select ‘Start’.
Disc Back-up
3
Read from disc and save to HDD.
Start reading?
HOME MENU
Cancel
Start
1
Select ‘Copy’, then ‘Disc
backup’ from the Home Menu.
• To see the progress of the backup, press
DISPLAY.
Note
1 When the copy mode is set to something other than High-Speed Copy for copying to a DVD-R/-RW ( Video mode)
or DVD+R/+RW, the chapter markers of the original are not copied. Chapter markers are put into the copy at
regular intervals, according to the Auto Chapter setting (see also Auto Chapter (Video) and Auto Chapter
(DVD+R/+RW) on page 136).
2 Optimized mode only available when copying to DVD. Due to remaining space on the disc or the title that you
copy, this mode does not always exactly fill a disc.
3 It is not possible to play this material directly from the HDD.
106
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying and backup
11
• You can cancel the backup process by
pressing ONE TOUCH COPY for more
than one second.
are using a DVD-RW or DVD+RW disc
you can re-initialize it in order to make it
usable again — see Initializing recordable
DVD discs on page 72.)
5
When the data has been copied, take
out the disc and load a blank* recordable
DVD.
* If you’re using a DVD-RW or DVD+RW, the
disc doesn’t have to be blank, although the
previous contents of the disc will be erased in
the backup process.
7
After the recorder has finished
recording the backup disc, you can select
whether to make another backup of the
same data or exit.
Disc Back-up
Disc back-up finished.
To make another back-up copy, please load
a recordable disc.
Disc Back-up
Disc content saved to Hard Disk Drive.
Please eject the disc and load a
recordable disc
Cancel
Start
• Select Start to make another backup
copy or Cancel to finish. If you want to
make another backup copy, return to
step 6 above.
Cancel
Start
You can use a DVD-R ver. 2.0, 2.1 or 2.2 disc,
or DVD-RW ver. 1.1 or ver. 1.2 disc for the
backup.
8
If you don’t need to keep the backup
data on the HDD, you can delete it now.
Select Yes to delete the data from the HDD;
select No to keep it (you can delete it later if
you want to).
• If you backup a DVD-R disc to DVD-RW,
you cannot undo the finalization later.
• Actual recordable capacity of discs vary
so there may be cases where the
contents of the disc you’re backing-up
will not fit on to a particular blank disc. If
this happens, please try another brand of
disc.
Disc Back-up
The backed-up data is still on the HDD.
Erasing it will increase the free space
available. OK to Erase?
No
Yes
• DVD-R/-RW discs can only be backed up
to DVD-R/-RW discs; DVD+R/+RW
discs can only be backed up to DVD+R/
+RW discs.
• If you decide to leave the backup data on
the HDD, you can make backup copies
to recordable DVD discs anytime from
the Disc Back-up menu.
6
Select ‘Start’ to start writing the
backed-up data to the blank disc.
Disc Back-up
Write back-up data from Hard Disk Drive.
The disc contents will be overwritten.
OK to start?
Cancel
Start
• To see the progress of the backup, press
DISPLAY.
• You can cancel the backup process by
pressing ONE TOUCH COPY for more
than one second. However, this will
make the disc unusable (although if you
107
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the Jukebox
12
Chapter 12
Using the Jukebox
The Jukebox feature allows you to use the
ENTER
recorder’s HDD to store and playback music
from up to 999 of your CDs. You can also
transfer WMA/MP3 files stored on CD-R/
-RW/-ROM, DVD, USB device or PC. Once on
the HDD, you can name albums and tracks,
assign them a genre, and set tracks that you
don’t want to play to Jump.
3
Select ‘DVD/CD to HDD’.
On pressing ENTER all tracks (or files) on the
CD or all WMA/MP3 files on the DVD are
copied to the HDD.
• You can also start copying by starting
playback of the CD/DVD and then
pressing ONE TOUCH COPY.
Copying music to the HDD
• To cancel copying press ENTER.
• If the CD loaded contains both CD audio
tracks and WMA/MP3 files, the part
currently selected will play.
The first step is to copy some music to the
HDD. CD audio, WMA and MP3 files are
copied at high speed. All tracks are copied
1
from each CD/DVD as an album.
Copying files via USB
WMA/MP3 album and track names are
copied along with the audio. CD album and
track names are not copied, but you can add
these later (see Editing Jukebox albums on
page 112).
Connecting a regular USB device
You can copy WMA or MP3 files from a
connected USB device, such as a USB drive,
to the HDD.
Usually, the tracks are copied to the HDD in
the order they appear on the CD/DVD.
1
2
Connect the USB device.
Note that once copied to the HDD, audio tracks
cannot be copied to a recordable DVD disc.
HOME MENU
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home
Menu.
Important
ENTER
3
Select ‘Listen to Music from
• While copying, no other recorder
operation is possible.
USB Device’.
• When copying, scheduled timer
recordings will not start until copying is
complete.
ENTER
4
Select ‘Copy Album’ from the
command menu panel.
• Copy protected CDs may not copy
successfully.
ENTER
5
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’
1
Load the CD/DVD you want to copy
to the HDD.
to cancel.
The selected folder on the USB device will be
copied to the HDD.
HOME MENU
2
Select ‘Copy’ from the Home
Menu.
Note
1 • Up to 999 albums can be created in the Jukebox. If you copy via Connect PC, the total number of albums you
are able to create may be less than 999 (for more information, see page 110).
• Sound quality is not worsened when you copy data from another source.
• When playing back an album copied from a source whose original audio track plays continuously (such as a
live recording), there will be a brief pause in sound between tracks.
108
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the Jukebox
12
• Up to 99 folders/999 files on the USB
device can be copied/displayed.
HOME MENU
2
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home
Menu.
Connect PC
ENTER
Using a USB connection, you can copy
WMA and MP3 files from a PC to the HDD of
this device. Operations carried out on the PC
require Windows Media Player 10.
3
Select ‘Connect PC’.
ENTER
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’
to cancel.
5
Verify that the import screen is
Important
displayed on the device.
• If the PC you are using does not currently
have Windows Media Player 10 installed,
you must first install the program and
make sure it functions correctly before
connecting the USB cable and attempting
to use the Connect PC function.
If no actions are carried out for 20 minutes,
the import screen is automatically closed. To
reopen it, you will have to repeat steps 2
through 4.
Number of copied
folders
Number of files
unable to be copied
Status
• For more information on Connect PC,
see Using a PC on page 23.
Connect PC
Standby
• You cannot edit or delete albums from
this device when it is connected to a PC
via USB. If you wish to edit or delete
albums via the Jukebox, you must first
disconnect the USB cable.
000 Folders
000000 Files
( 000 error
( 000 error
)
)
Exit
1
Connect the PC via USB cable.
The screen below is displayed. Choose ‘Take
Number of copied files
Open Windows Media Player 10 on
the PC.
The device settings screen appears. Click
‘Cancel’.
no action’ and click ‘OK’.
6
*Depending on the settings for Windows
Media Player 10, the screen shown below
may not be displayed.
'Take no action'
*Depending on the settings for Windows
Media Player 10, the screen shown below
may not be displayed.
'Cancel'
109
En
'OK'
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the Jukebox
12
From the PC, in Windows Media Player 10:
7
When you have finished copying
files, close Windows Media Player 10 on
the PC.
1. Click ‘Library’.
2. Choose the artist, album or song
you would like to copy, and press the
right mouse button.
3. Click ‘Add to Sync list’ (when
choosing songs, click ‘Add to’ then
‘Sync list’).
ENTER
8
Close the import screen on this
device.
• If no actions are carried out for 20
minutes after copying, the import screen
is automatically closed.
4. Click ‘Start Sync’.
This begins the synchronization process.
When finished, the message ‘Synchronized
to Device’ is displayed in Windows Media
Player 10.
Note
• When using the sync function of
Windows Media Player 10, music, artist
and album folders are created as
follows:
Root
music1.mp3
music2.mp3
Music
Artist 1
Album 1
music1.wma
Album 2
Album 1
music1.mp3
Artist 2
'Start Sync'
• Folders containing no files are not
displayed in the Jukebox (such as the
above ‘Artist1’ and ‘Artist2’ folders), but
do count toward the maximum of 999
folders allowed in Jukebox.
For more information refer to the Help menu
of Windows Media Player 10.
Progress Bar
• Up to 999 tracks can be included in one
album. Note that when there are many
tracks contained in one album, it may
take time to display and transfer these
tracks.
Connect PC
Copying
001 Folders
000003 Files
( 000 error
( 000 error
)
)
Exit
• Albums and tracks with no set name that
are transferred from CD/DVD/USB are
displayed as ‘UnknownAlbum’ and
‘UnknownFile’ in Windows Media Player
10.
• To cancel the synchronization process
while it is underway, press ENTER on the
remote control. The Connect PC screen
is closed.
• Album and track names that do not
conform to the ISO8859-1 standard may
display differently in Windows Media
Player 10 and the Jukebox.
• If synchronization fails, make sure that
the Pioneer. HDD/DVD-Recorder device
is selected at the synchronization screen
of Windows Media Player 10, and try
again.
• When albums are deleted in the
Jukebox, their file hierarchy as displayed
in Windows Media Player may change.
110
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the Jukebox
12
• File whose extensions are not supported
by the Jukebox (i.e. files that are not
.mp3 or .wma) cannot be transferred.
• If you want to start playback from a
selected track in an album, or play a
track that is set to Jump, press ꢀ to
enter the track list then select a track to
play.
• Files imported to this recorder via
Connect PC cannot be exported from
this recorder.
Track name
• Note that no recording functions,
including timer recordings, will be
carried out when you are using the
Connect PC function.
Jukebox
10Albums
3
4
Album1
Album2
ALL
1
Play
Erase
Edit
Mars
By number
5
6
7
8
9
Album3
Album4
Album5
Album6
Album7
2
Venus
3
Mercury
Jupiter
Saturn
Uranus
Neptune
Play Mode
4
All Genres
5
Genre Name
6
7
Playing music from the
Jukebox
10 Album8
Jupiter
HDD
3-10
ꢃ
classical
MP3
8 MB
0.03.58
Remain
47.0
G
You can select albums or individual tracks
from the Jukebox to play.
• Press
change the page.
SUBTITLE or
ANGLE to
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home
Menu.
Changing the album view
ENTER
2
Select a Jukebox option.
1
From the album list, display
• Listen to Music/Edit – Listen to CDs or
WMA/MP3 files that have been copied to
the HDD.
the view options menu panel.
ENTER
• Listen to Music from USB device –
Listen to music from an external USB
device.
2
Select a view option.
Jukebox
10Albums
bum1
ALL
1
Play
Sort
By number m2
Erase
Edit
By
By favourite
ENTER
m3
m4
m5
m6
m7
2
By album
Genr
3
3
Select what you want to play.
Play Mode
4
A
Cancel
5
The screen below shows albums stored on
the HDD:
Genre Name
6
7
m8
Album1 The Planets/Mars-Venus-Mercury-Jup
iter-Saturn-Uranus-Nep classical
Total 12 70 MB
HDD
G
3-10
ꢃ
0.03.58
Album name
Remain
47.0
Jukebox
10Albums
• Sort order
3
4
Album1
Album2
ALL
1
Play
Erase
Edit
By number – Albums are listed by the
album number.
By number
5
6
7
8
9
Album3
Album4
Album5
Album6
Album7
2
3
Play Mode
4
All Genres
By favourite – Most often listened to
music appears at the top of the list.
5
Genre Name
6
7
10 Album8
By album – Albums are listed
alphabetically.
Album1 The Planets/Mars-Venus-Mercury-Jup
HDD
3-10
ꢃ
0.03.58
iter-Saturn-Uranus-Nep
Total 12 70 MB
classical
Remain
47.0
G
Info for selected album
Playback status
• If you select a whole album to play, all
tracks that are not set to Jump will play.
111
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the Jukebox
12
• Genre
Editing Jukebox albums
Jukebox
10Albums
A number of commands are available for
editing and changing the playback behavior
of albums.
bum1
m2
ALL
1
Play
Erase
Edit
Sort
All Genre
s
By
No Category
m3
m4
m5
m6
m7
2
Best
Genr
3
Rock
Play Mode
Pop
4
A
Jazz
HOME MENU
5
1
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home
Genre Name
Classical
6
Menu.
7
m8
Album1 The Planets/Mars-Venus-Mercury-Jup
iter-Saturn-Uranus-Nep classical
Total 12 70 MB
HDD
G
3-10
ꢀ
0.03.58
ENTER
ENTER
ENTER
Remain
47.0
2
3
4
Select ‘Listen to Music/Edit’.
Select what you want to edit.
Select an edit function from
All Genres – All albums are displayed.
Genre – Only albums in the selected
genre are displayed.
the command menu panel.
• Erase – Erase the selected track (if all
tracks in an album are selected, the
whole album is erased).
• Edit > Album name – Enter a name of
up to 64 characters for the album. See
Title Name on page 91 for how to enter
names.
• Edit > Track name – Enter a name of up
to 64 characters for the track. See Title
Name on page 91 for how to enter
names.
• Edit > Set Genre – Set or change the
genre for the album.
1
• Edit > Jump Set – Set a track to jump
so that it doesn’t play (choose this
command again to cancel the Jump
setting).
• Play Mode – Change the playback order
for albums and tracks.
• Genre Name – Enter a name of up to 12
characters for a genre. See Title Name
on page 91 for how to enter names.
Note
112
En
1 Tracks set to Jump will be skipped during consecutive track playback.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
Chapter 13
The PhotoViewer
From the PhotoViewer you can view JPEG
photos and picture files stored on the HDD,
recordable DVD or CD-R/-RW/-ROM, or on a
USB-equipped digital camera. You can also
import files and save them to the recorder’s
HDD or a DVD-R/-RW disc.
The first image from the selected folder is
displayed as thumbnail at the bottom of the
screen. From the Folder Information
column, you can change thumbnails via the
ꢈ/ꢉ buttons.
1
Currently selected
folder in folder list
PhotoViewer HDD
Locating JPEG picture files
Select Folder
001 Folder1
002
003
004
005
Folder2
Folder3
Folder4
Folder5
HOME MENU
Folder
1
Select ‘PhotoViewer’ from the
Home Menu.
FOLDER
MENU
006 Folder6
007
008
Folder7
Folder8
ENTER
2
Select the location of the files
HDD
002 Folder2
Files
Folder
999
999 MB
Remain
100.0
you want to view or edit.
1/3
G
Pages in
folder list
View/Edit Photos on the HDD
View Photos on a CD/DVD
Folder information
View Photos on a USB Device
Copy Files from a Digital Camera
4
Select the file you want to
view, copy or edit.
• View/Edit Photos on the HDD – View
or edit photos already stored on the
recorder’s HDD.
Currently selected
thumbnail
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
• View Photos on a CD/DVD – View
photos on a Fujicolor CD, CD-ROM,
CD-R/-RW, or DVD-R/-RW.
Folder Size 999 MB
001 PIOR0000
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
File
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
FILE
MENU
• View Photos on a USB Device – View
photos on a digital camera (or other USB
device) connected to the USB port.
12 Files
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
HDD
• Copy Files from a Digital Camera –
Copy all DCF files directly from a
connected digital camera to a
recordable DVD-R/-RW.
Remain
100.0
1/84
G
Pages in
file list
• The larger the file size, the longer it takes
the recorder to load the file.
ENTER
3
Select the folder containing
• You can change folders via the ꢈ/ꢉ
buttons.
the files you want to view, copy or edit.
Note
1 Up to 999 files or 99 folders are viewable, but if there are more files/folders than this on the disc or connected
USB camera it is still possible to view them all using the Reload function (see Reloading files from a disc or USB
device on page 115).
113
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
• If you encounter a disc that will not play,
check that the disc and file formats are
compatible with this recorder (see JPEG
file compatibility and PC-created disc
compatibility on page 11).
Playing a slideshow
ENTER
1
Select a folder from the folder
• The thumbnail of files that cannot be
list.
played is displayed as the
logo.
To start the slideshow from the first file in the
folder, skip to step 3 after choosing the
desired folder and pressing ꢀ.
Changing the display style of
the PhotoViewer
You can choose to display photos by
grouping them by folder, file, or number of
thumbnails.
2
Select a thumbnail.
• Use ꢆ PREV and ꢇ NEXT to display
the previous/next page of thumbnails.
ENTER
3
Select ‘Start Slideshow’ or
1
Display the View Options
‘Start Audio Slideshow’ from the menu.
When you select ‘Start Audio Slideshow’,
you are prompted to select the Genre of
music you would like to hear, and when you
press ENTER, music of that Genre stored on
the Jukebox will be played during the
slideshow.
panel.
The View Options panel
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
Folder Size 999 MB
PIOR0000
Display Mode
PIOR0001
PIOR0002
PIOR0003
PIOR0004
PIOR0005
PIOR0006
PIOR0007
PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
File
Style
For more information on adding music to the
HDD, see Using the Jukebox on page 108.
12 Files
FILE
MENU
• You can also select a file or folder then
press ꢃ PLAY to start playing the
slideshow.
HDD
Remain
100.0
1/84
G
• Use ꢆ PREV/ꢇ NEXT to display the
previous/next picture, or ꢅ PAUSE to
pause the slideshow.
ENTER
2
Choose ‘Display Mode’ or
• Depending on the aspect ratio, some
pictures may be displayed with black
bars top and bottom, or left and right.
‘Style’ then press ENTER to see the
available view options.
• Display Mode – Choose between folder
and file display modes.
• Large picture files may take a few
seconds to display. This is normal.
• Style – Choose between displays of 1, 4
and 12 thumbnails.
STOP
4
5
Press to return to the thumbnail.
• You can also use the RETURN/EXIT
button.
ENTER
3
Choose a view option, then
press ENTER.
The display mode will change to that which
HOME MENU
Press to exit the PhotoViewer.
you have chosen.
114
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
Zooming an image
Importing files to the HDD
During a slideshow you can zoom in to
enlarge a portion of the picture by a factor of
two or four. You can also move the area of
the picture displayed.
You can import files and save them to the
2
HDD from a CD, DVD or a connected USB
camera. Once on the HDD you can edit and
organize your pictures and print them out if
you’ve connected a PictBridge-compatible
printer.
ENTER
1
Press during the slideshow to
zoom the picture.
Repeated presses cycle between zoom off,
2x zoom and 4x zoom. The zoom factor is
displayed on-screen.
ENTER
1
Select the location of folders/
files you want to import.
To import a whole folder, select the desired
folder, press ꢀ, and skip to step 3 below.
2
Use to move the zoomed
area.
• To import multiple folders, use the Multi-
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or
folders on page 116.
Rotating an image
You can rotate the displayed picture during a
slideshow so you can always view pictures
the right way up, whichever way they were
taken.
2
Select a file to import, then
press ꢀ
.
ANGLE
• To import multiple files, use the Multi-
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or
folders on page 116.
•
Press during the slideshow to
rotate the displayed picture clockwise by
90º.
Press repeatedly to continue rotating the
ENTER
picture in increments of 90º.
3
Select ‘Copy to HDD’ from the
menu.
Reloading files from a disc or
USB device
PhotoViewer CD/DVD
Folder2
Folder Size 999 MB
Start Slideshow
001 PIOR0000
002 PIOR0001
Copy all to HDD
Copy to HDD
File
If you have a disc with more than 1000 files
and/or 100 folders, you can still view all the
images using the reload function.
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
Print
Detailed Information
12 Files
Multi-Mode
HDD
Remain
100.0
1/84
G
1
Navigate to the last entry in
the folder list (‘Read next: ...’).
ENTER
ENTER
2
Load the next batch of up to 999
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm and
files/99 folders from the disc or
connected USB device.
It will take a moment (at most a few minutes)
copy the folder(s)/file(s), or ‘No’ to
cancel.
• The files will be copied to the HDD with
1
the same folder structure as the original.
to load in the images.
Note
1 You can press HOME MENU to exit the PhotoViewer screen while the recorder is reloading images. (If you enter
the PhotoViewer again, it will resume reloading.)
2 For files you want to keep permanently, we recommend backing up to DVD-R/-RW.
115
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
• Importing to the HDD will not work if
there is insufficient space on the HDD,
or if there are already the maximum
number of files and/or folders on the
HDD (999 folders/999 files per folder).
ENTER
4
list.
Select files/folders from the
An orange check mark box (ꢅ) is shown by
the item you selected. A blue check mark
box (ꢅ) appears on the folder select screen
when files from that folder are selected.
Selecting multiple files or
folders
PhotoViewer HDD
Multi-Mode
Select Folder
001 Folder1
The Multi-Mode allows you to select multiple
folders/files at once for importing or editing.
02
003
004
005
Folder2
Folder3
Folder4
Folder5
Folder
FOLDER
MENU
ENTER
006 Folder6
1
Select the folder containing
007
008
Folder7
Folder8
the files you want to import.
HDD
002 Folder2
Files
999
Remain
100.0
Folder
999 MB
1/3
G
2
Display the command menu.
5
6
Display the command menu.
Select the command you want
ENTER
3
Select ‘Multi-Mode’ from the
ENTER
menu.
to apply to all the selected items.
PhotoViewer HDD
Select Folder
001 Folder1
Start Slideshow
Start Audio Slideshow
New Folder
002
003
004
005
Folder2
Folder3
Folder4
Folder5
Copying files to a DVD-R/-RW
Folder
Folder Options
Copy to DVD
Multi-Mode
1
Using this feature you can copy all the files
006 Folder6
007
008
Folder7
Folder8
(including audio and movie files) stored on a
connected USB camera to a recordable DVD
disc.
HDD
G
002 Folder2
Files
Folder
999
999 MB
Remain
100.0
1/3
A slideshow of the files is also recorded on
the disc as a Video mode title, making it
possible to view the photos on other DVD
players/recorders that may not be
compatible with JPEG file playback.
Once the files have been copied, the disc is
automatically finalized.
Note
1 • There is a limit to the number of files/amount of data that you can copy at one time.
• Only DCF format files in DCIM folders can be copied to a recordable DVD-R/-RW.
116
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
Important
Important
• A maximum of 99 slideshow titles can be
recorded.
• Use a blank DVD-R/-RW disc, or one that
has already been initialized for Video
mode recording but has nothing yet
recorded on it. Discs that have already
been recorded on (as well as CD-R/-RW
discs) cannot be used.
• One slideshow title can contain up to 99
files. If there are more files than this in
the slideshow, multiple slideshows are
created on the disc.
• If you erase a slideshow title from a DVD
the slideshow will become unplayable
but the free space will not increase.
• After backing up the pictures in your
digital camera to DVD, we recommend
verifying that they have been recorded
properly before deleting anything from
the camera.
1
Load a blank (or unfinalized Video
mode) DVD-R or DVD-RW disc.
1
Press HOME MENU and select
ENTER
‘PhotoViewer’ to display the
PhotoViewer screen.
2
Select ‘View/Edit Photos on
the HDD’ from the menu.
2
Load a blank (or unrecorded Video
mode) DVD-R or DVD-RW disc.
Select ‘Copy Files from a Digital
ENTER
3
3
Select the file(s) or folder(s)
Camera’ from the menu.
you want to copy.
• Copying a folder will copy all the files
contained in it.
View/Edit Photos on the HDD
View Photos on a CD/DVD
• To copy multiple folders, use the Multi-
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or
folders on page 116.
View Photos on a USB Device
Copy Files from a Digital Camera
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’ to
ENTER
cancel.
4
Select ‘Copy to DVD’ from the
• Note that during copying, any timer
programmes set to start will not begin,
and no other operations are possible.
menu.
ENTER
5
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’
Copying selected files to a
DVD-R/-RW
to cancel.
• Folder names on the disc will be
number PIONR. File names will be
PHOT number.
This feature allows you just to copy some of
the files stored on HDD to a DVD.
• Note that during copying, any timer
programmes set to start will not begin,
and no other operation is possible.
A slideshow of the files is also recorded on
the disc as a Video mode title, making it
possible to view the photos on other DVD
players/recorders that may not be
• While ‘Cancel’ is displayed, you can
press ENTER to cancel.
compatible with JPEG file playback. Note
however that you may need to finalize the
disc before it will play on another DVD player
(copying selected files doesn’t automatically
finalize the disc).
117
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
Editing files on the HDD
There are a number of commands you can
use to edit and organize your pictures stored
on the HDD.
2
3
Display the command menu.
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder
ENTER
Creating a new folder
Options’.
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
Folder Size 999 MB
Start Slideshow
001 PIOR0000
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
1
From the folder list, display
Start Audio Slideshow
File Options
Print
File
the menu.
Copy to DVD
12 Files
Detailed Information
Multi-Mode
ENTER
2
Select ‘New Folder’.
HDD
The folder appears at the bottom of the folder
list with the name F_number.
Remain
1/84
100.0
G
PhotoViewer HDD
Select Folder
ENTER
4
Select ‘Erase’ or ‘Erase Folder’.
001 Folder1
Start Slideshow
002
003
004
005
Folder2
Folder3
Folder4
Folder5
Start Audio Slideshow
New Folder
Folder
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
Folder Options
Copy to DVD
Multi-Mode
Folder Size 999 MB
006 Folder6
001 PIOR0000
Erase
Copy
007
008
Folder7
Folder8
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
File
Rename File
HDD
002 Folder2
Files
Folder
Lock
999
999 MB
12 Files
Remain
100.0
1/3
G
Cancel
• There can be up to 999 folders on the
HDD.
HDD
Remain
100.0
1/84
G
Erasing a file or folder
ENTER
5
to cancel.
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’
1
Select the file(s) or folder(s)
• You can also erase a file or folder by
pressing CLEAR when the file or folder is
highlighted. Press ENTER to confirm.
you want to erase.
• To erase multiple files or folders, use the
Multi-Mode; see Selecting multiple files
or folders on page 116.
Copying files
• Erasing a folder will erase all the files
contained in it. Please be careful!
• You can’t erase files that have been
locked.
1
Select the file(s) or folder(s)
you want to copy.
• Folders containing locked files can’t be
erased. Unlocked files in the folder,
however, will be erased.
• Copying a folder will copy all the files
contained in it.
• To copy multiple files or folders, use the
Multi-Mode; see Selecting multiple files
or folders on page 116.
118
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
3
Select ‘Rename File’ or ‘Rename
Folder’.
2
3
Display the command menu.
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
Folder Size 999 MB
001 PIOR0000
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
ENTER
Erase
Copy
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder
Select ‘Copy’ or ‘Copy Folder
File
Rename File
Options’.
Lock
12 Files
Cancel
ENTER
4
HDD
Remain
100.0
Contents’.
1/84
G
4
Enter a new name for the file/folder.
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
Folder Size 999 MB
File names or Folder names can be up to 64
characters long.
001 PIOR0000
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
Erase
Copy
File
See Using the remote key shortcuts to input
a name and Using a USB keyboard to enter a
name on page 92 for how to enter a name.
Rename File
Lock
12 Files
Cancel
HDD
Locking/Unlocking files
Locking files will protect them from
accidental erasure and prevent them from
being renamed.
Remain
1/84
100.0
G
ENTER
5
Select a folder to copy the
folder(s)/file(s) to.
Use the same process to both lock and
unlock files. Locked files are displayed in the
PhotoViewer with a padlock icon.
ENTER
6
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’
to cancel.
• Copying to the HDD will not work if there
is insufficient space on the HDD; if there
are already the maximum number of
files and/or folders on the HDD.
1
Select the file(s) you want to
lock (or unlock).
• To lock/unlock multiple files or folders,
use the Multi-Mode; see Selecting
multiple files or folders on page 116.
Naming files and folders
1
Select the file or folder you want to
2
3
Display the command menu.
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder
rename.
You can’t rename files that have been
locked.
ENTER
2
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder
Options’.
Options’.
119
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The PhotoViewer
13
ENTER
4
Select ‘Lock’ or ‘Lock Folder
2
3
Display the command menu.
Select ‘Print’ from the menu.
Contents’.
PhotoViewer HDD
ENTER
Folder2
Folder Size 999 MB
001 PIOR0000
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
Erase
Copy
File
Rename File
PhotoViewer HDD
Folder2
Lock
Folder Size 999 MB
Start Slideshow
12 Files
001 PIOR0000
Cancel
002 PIOR0001
003 PIOR0002
004 PIOR0003
005 PIOR0004
006 PIOR0005
007 PIOR0006
008 PIOR0007
009 PIOR0008
010 PIOR0009
011 PIOR0010
012 PIOR0011
Start Audio Slideshow
File Options
Print
File
HDD
Copy to DVD
Remain
100.0
12 Files
1/84
Detailed Information
Multi-Mode
G
Locked files are shown with a padlock icon
next to them. To remove all locks within a
given folder, choose ‘Folder Option’ >
‘Unlock Folder Contents’.
HDD
Remain
100.0
1/84
G
ENTER
To view detailed information
This feature allows you to check the settings
of the camera from which you imported the
photos.
4
Select ‘Start’ to confirm, or
‘Cancel’ to cancel.
• Once printing has started, you can
cancel by pressing ENTER.
1
Choose the file for which you would
like to see detailed information.
Choose ‘Detailed Information’.
Tip
2
• Paper size and layout can be set; the
options available depend on your printer
— check the printer manual for details.
When no detailed information is available,
nothing is displayed.
• This recorder may not work correctly
with all printers.
Printing files
Connecting a PictBridge-compatible printer
to the USB port will enable you to print out
1
picture files stored on the HDD, a CD/DVD,
or directly from a digital camera.
Make sure that the printer (and your digital
camera if you are using that as a source) is
connected to the recorder before starting.
1
Select the file(s) you want to
print.
• To print multiple files, use the Multi-
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or
folders on page 116.
Note
120
En
1 Picture files should be standard DCF format. Non-standard files may not print properly.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Disc Setup menu
14
Chapter 14
The Disc Setup menu
From the Disc Setup menu you can name
discs, lock the contents to prevent
accidental recording and erasure, initialize
and finalize discs. The Disc Setup menu is
accessed from the Home menu.
Lock Disc
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM
• Default setting: Off
Locking the disc will prevent accidental
recording, editing or erasing of the disc.
Basic settings
Important
Input Disc Name
• A locked disc can still be initialized
(which will completely erase the disc).
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
When you initialize a disc for recording, the
recorder automatically assigns a name for
the disc ranging from DISC 1 to DISC 99. You
can use the Input Disc Name function to
change the default disc name to something
more descriptive. This name appears when
you load the disc and when you display disc
information on-screen.
Home Menu.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Basic’ > ‘Lock Disc’
then ‘On’ or ‘Off’.
Disc Setup
On
Off
Basic
Input Disc Name
Initialize
Finalize
Lock Disc
DVD-RW Auto Init.
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
Optimize HDD
Home Menu.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Basic’ > ‘Input Disc
Set to On to prevent accidental recording,
editing or erasing of the disc loaded. If you
need to unlock the disc to make edits, select
Off.
Name’ > ‘Next Screen’.
Disc Setup
Input Disc Name
Lock Disc
Next Screen
Basic
Initialize
Finalize
DVD-RW Auto Init.
Optimize HDD
DVD-RW Auto Initialize
DVD-RW
• Default setting: VR Mode
Initialization mode is automatically carried
out when you insert a blank DVD-RW. You
must set the desired initialization mode
before inserting a disc.
ENTER
3
Input a name for the disc.
The disc name can be up to 64 characters
long for a VR mode disc, or 40 for a Video
mode discs and DVD+R/+RW.
See DVD-RW Auto Initialize on page 73 for
detailed instructions.
• See Title Name on page 91 for more on
navigating the input screen.
121
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Disc Setup menu
14
Undo Finalize
Initialize settings
DVD-RW
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+RW DVD-RAM
You can undo the finalization on DVD-RW
discs recorded on this recorder in Video
mode. You need to do this if you want to
record more material or edit material already
on the disc.
You can initialize a recordable DVD-R/-RW
disc for either VR mode or Video mode
recording.
The first time you load a new DVD-RW disc,
it will be automatically initialized for
recording according to the DVD-RW Auto
Init. setting in the Disc Setup menu (see
page 73).
You can also undo the finalization of VR
mode discs which have been finalized on
other DVD recorders. If when you load a disc
the message This disc cannot be recorded.
Undo the finalization. is displayed, use
this command to be able to record on the
disc using this recorder.
New DVD-R discs are ready for Video mode
recording when you load them, but it is also
possible to initialize them for VR mode
1
recording.
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
DVD+RW and DVD-RAM discs can also be
initialized as a way of erasing the entire disc.
When initializing a DVD-RAM disc, select VR
mode.
Home Menu.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Finalize’ > ‘Undo
See Initializing recordable DVD discs on
page 72 for detailed instructions.
Finalize’ then ‘Start’.
Optimize HDD
Finalize settings
HDD
Finalize
As you record, erase and edit recordings, the
HDD file system gradually becomes
fragmented. Periodically, the HDD will need
optimizing to ‘clean up’ all the fragmented
files.
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+R DVD+RW
Finalizing ‘fixes’ the recordings in place so
that the disc can be played on a regular DVD
player or computer equipped with a suitable
DVD-ROM drive.
When the HDD needs optimizing the
recorder will automatically display a
message recommending optimization.
It is also possible to finalize DVD+RW discs.
This is only necessary if you want to a player
to display a title menu for the disc.
Important
See Playing your recordings on other DVD
players on page 71 for detailed instructions.
• Optimizing the HDD can take as long as
eight hours. During optimization,
playback and recording are not possible.
• Cancelling optimization mid-way does
not undo the optimization already done,
so the HDD will be partly optimized.
Note
1 Once initialized for VR mode recording it is not possible to re-initialize the disc for Video mode recording. Also,
once recorded in Video mode, the disc cannot be re-initialized for VR mode recording.
122
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Disc Setup menu
14
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
Home Menu.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Optimize HDD’ then
‘Start’.
Disc Setup
Start
Basic
Optimize HDD
Initialize
Finalize
Optimize HDD
A progress bar indicates how long there is
left to go. If no actions are carried out for
more than 20 minutes after the optimization
process is completed, the unit turns itself
off.
Initialize HDD
HDD
When your HDD/DVD recorder is working
without a problem this option is not visible in
the Disc Setup menu. However, if the HDD
file system becomes corrupted for some
reason, you can initialize the HDD to fix the
problem. Note that initializing the HDD will
erase all the data on it.
HOME MENU
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the
Home Menu.
ENTER
2
Select ‘Initialize HDD’ then
‘Start’.
Disc Setup
Start
Basic
Initialize HDD
Initialize
Finalize
InitializeHDD
123
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Video Adjust menu
15
Chapter 15
The Video Adjust menu
Using the Video Adjust menu you can set up
the picture quality for the built-in tuner and
external inputs, for disc playback, and for
recording.
• Memory1 – user preset 1
• Memory2 – user preset 2
• Memory3 – user preset 3
You can press DISPLAY to see the individual
settings for the current preset (Tuner, VCR
or DTV/LDP).
Setting the picture quality
for TV and external inputs
Creating your own set
There are three user presets in which you
can save your own set of picture quality
settings.
Picture Creation lets you choose a set of
picture quality settings for the built-in TV
1
tuner and for each external input. There are
several preset settings that suit various
sources, or you can create up to three of your
own sets.
1
Follow Choosing a preset above and
select one of the user presets (Memory 1,
2 or 3).
Choosing a preset
ENTER
2
Select ‘Detailed Settings’.
HOME MENU
1
With the recorder stopped,
press to display the Home Menu.
Pr 1
Memory1
ENTER
Detailed Settings
2
3
Select ‘Video Adjust’.
ENTER
ENTER
3
Select the setting you want to
Select a preset.
adjust.
Pr 1
Memory1
Pr
1
Tuner
Detailed Settings
Prog. Motion
PureCinma
3-D Y/C
YNR
Motion
Still
Auto
• Use the INPUT SELECT button to switch
between the built-in TV tuner and the
external inputs.
Motion
Off
Still
Max
Max
Max
CNR
Off
• Use the Smart Jog to change the
channel of the built-in TV tuner.
Detail
Off
White AGC
Off
There are six presets available:
You can adjust the following settings:
• Tuner – suitable for general TV
• Prog. Motion – Adjusts the motion and
still picture quality when video output is
set to progressive.
broadcasts
• VCR – suitable for video cassettes
• DTV/LDP – suitable for digital
broadcasts and Laserdiscs
Note
1 When the Component Video Out (see page 131) is set to Interlace, the settings for the digital tuner cannot be
changed.
124
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Video Adjust menu
15
• PureCinema – This setting optimizes the
picture for film material when the video
output is set to progressive. Usually set
to Auto; but try switching to Off if the
picture appears unnatural.
Setting the picture quality
for disc playback
This setting determines how the picture will
look when playing discs.
• 3-D Y/C – Adjusts the brightness/colour
separation.
Choosing a preset
• YNR – Adjusts the amount of noise
reduction (NR) applied to the Y
(brightness) component.
HOME MENU
1
With a disc playing (or paused),
press to display the Home Menu.
• CNR – Adjusts the amount of noise
reduction (NR) applied to the C (colour)
component.
ENTER
2
3
Select ‘Video Adjust’.
Select a setting.
• Detail – Adjusts how sharp edges
appear.
ENTER
• White AGC – Turn on for automatic
white level adjustment.
TV
• White Level – Adjusts the intensity of
white.
Detailed Settings
• Black Level – Adjusts the intensity of
black.
There are six presets available:
• TV – suitable for LCD and cathode-ray
tube TVs
• Black Setup – Corrects the standard
reference black level (525 Input Line
System only).
• PDP – suitable for plasma display
screens
• Hue – Adjusts overall balance between
red and green.
• Professional – suitable for professional
monitors
• Chroma Level – Adjusts how rich the
colours appear.
• Memory1 – user preset 1
• Memory2 – user preset 2
• Memory3 – user preset 3
ENTER
4
Adjust the currently selected
You can press DISPLAY to see the individual
settings for the current preset (TV, PDP or
Professional).
setting.
HOME MENU
5
Press to exit.
You can now use the preset for any other
input or the built-in TV tuner.
Creating your own set
There are three user presets in which you
can save your own set of picture quality
settings for disc playback.
Tip
• To see more of the picture as you adjust
different settings, press ENTER after
selecting the setting you want to adjust.
1
Follow Choosing a preset above and
select one of the user presets (Memory 1,
2 or 3).
125
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Video Adjust menu
15
2
Move the cursor down and select
• White Level – Adjusts the intensity of
white. White Level is ineffective for HDMI
output.
‘Detailed Settings’.
• Black Level – Adjusts the intensity of
black. Black Level is ineffective for HDMI
output.
Memory1
Detailed Settings
3
Select the picture quality setting you
• Black Setup – Corrects the standard
reference black level. Black Setup is
ineffective for HDMI output.
want to adjust.
Memory1
• Gamma Correction – Adjusts the
brightness of darker images. Gamma
Correction is ineffective for HDMI
output.
Prog. Motion
PureCinma
Motion
Still
Auto1
YNR
Off
Off
Max
Max
Max
Fine
Fine
BNR
• Hue – Adjusts overall balance between
red and green. Hue is ineffective for
HDMI output.
MNR
Off
Sharpness
Detail
Soft
Soft
• Chroma Level – Adjusts how rich the
colours appear. Chroma Level is
ineffective for HDMI output.
You can adjust the following settings:
• Prog. Motion – Adjusts the motion and
still picture quality when video output is
set to progressive. (Prog. Motion is
4
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to adjust the
currently selected picture quality setting.
ineffective when PureCinema is On.)
5
When you have all the settings as you
want them, press HOME MENU to exit.
• PureCinema – This setting optimizes the
picture for film material when the video
output is set to progressive. Usually set
to Auto 1 but try switching to Auto 2,
On or Off if the picture appears
unnatural.
Tip
• To see more of the picture as you adjust
different settings, press ENTER after
selecting the setting you want to adjust.
• YNR – Adjusts the amount of noise
reduction (NR) applied to the Y
(brightness) component.
• BNR – Adjusts the amount of noise
reduction (NR) applied to the block noise
(artefacts visible in areas of flat colour,
caused by MPEG compression).
• MNR – Adjusts the amount of noise
reduction (NR) applied to the mosquito
noise (artefacts visible around the edges
of an image, caused by MPEG
compression).
• Sharpness – Adjusts the sharpness of
the high-frequency (detailed) elements
in the picture. Sharpness is ineffective
for HDMI output.
• Detail – Adjusts how sharp edges
appear.
126
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Chapter 16
The Initial Setup menu
Using the Initial Setup menu
The Initial Setup menu is where you can set various recorder options for sound, picture,
language and so on.
Some settings can only be changed when the recorder is stopped. During playback and
recording these settings are grayed out in the Initial Setup menu.
Except for the Setup Navigator, menu screens are exited automatically after 20 minutes of
inactivity.
•
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Initial Setup’.
In the table below, the default option is marked with a •.
Setting
Options
Explanation
Basic
Clock Setting
Auto
Set the channel that broadcasts a clock signal and
the clock will be set automatically.
Manual •
If there is no channel that broadcasts a clock signal
in your area, you can set the time and date manually.
• If any digital TV channels are set then the clock will automatically be set.
• The clock must be set in order to use timer recording.
Input Line System
525 System
Use for NTSC or PAL-60 recording from an external
input.
625 System •
Use for standard PAL or SECAM recording.
• This setting is applicable only when recording from an external input.
• See also About the input line system on page 141 for more information on this setting.
Power Save
Mode 1
Only signals arriving at the antenna input are passed
through to the antenna output when the recorder is
in standby.
Mode 2
Off •
No input signals are passed through to the outputs
when the recorder is in standby.
When the recorder is in standby, all signals arriving
at the SCART and antenna inputs are passed along
to the outputs.
HELP Setting
On •
Off
Switches on the automatic Help screens for GUI
displays.
Switches off the automatic Help screens for GUI
displays. (Press HELP on the remote to manually
display the Help screen.)
127
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
EPG Type Select
GUIDE Plus+
Digital EPG
Use the Gemstar GUIDE Plus+ EPG.
Use the EPG based on information provided by D.TV
broadcasts.
Setup Navigator
Start
Select to start the Setup Navigator. See also
Switching on and setting up on page 30.
Digital Tuner
Replace Channels
Next Screen
Scans for digital channels and replaces all the
channel presets with the results. Before the scan
starts you will need to select your country.
After the scan is complete the recorder tells you
whether any new channels were found, and if so,
how many.
(You can cancel the scan before it has finished by
pressing HOME MENU or RETURN/EXIT. In this
case, no channels are set.)
If you execute a Replace Channels command, any timer recordings set for D.TV channels will be erased.
Add New Channels Next Screen
Automatically scans for new digital channels.
After the scan is complete the recorder tells you
whether any new channels were found, and if so,
how many.
(You can cancel the scan before it has finished by
pressing HOME MENU or RETURN/EXIT. In this
case, no new channels are set.)
Channel Sort
Next Screen
Use this screen to sort channel presets into your
prefered order. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to
highlight the channel you want to move, press
ENTER. Use the cursor buttons again to highlight the
position you want to move the channel preset to,
then press ENTER again.
(If there are more channel presets than will fit on one
screen, you can select the next/previous page by
highlighting the small triangular marks and pressing
ENTER.)
128
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
Channel Options
Next Screen
From this screen you can skip or lock channels.
Locked channels will require the correct password to
be entered before the channel can be watched. Use
the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to highlight a preference box
and press ENTER to toggle the preference.
To enter this screen, input the parental lock password
when prompted (if one has not yet been set then the
password you enter becomes the parental lock
password).
Auto Skip
Off •
No channels are automatically skipped.
Radio
Radio channels are skipped when selecting
channels.
Data
Data channels are skipped when selecting channels.
Radio & Data
Radio and data channels are skipped when selecting
channels.
Signal Check
Aerial Power
Next Screen
Use this screen to check the signal level and quality
of digital channels. Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to change
the RF channel; select Add New Channels then
press ENTER to scan for new channels; press HOME
MENU to exit.
On
Power is supplied to the connected aerial (antenna)
when this recorder is on or in standby.
Auto
Off •
Power is supplied to the connected aerial (antenna)
only when this recorder is on.
This recorder does not supply power to the
connected aerial (antenna).
• If the setting keeps reverting to Off when you try to set to On or Auto, the aerial may not be connected properly,
or it may be shorted. In either case, check the connection and try making the setting again.
D.TV Language
Next Screen
From this screen you can set your Primary and
Secondary Audio preference for multilingual digital
broadcasts, your Primary and Secondary Subtitle
preference for programmes that are broadcast with
subtitles, and your Teletext language preference. Use
the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to highlight a field then use the ꢃ/
ꢀ buttons to change it.
129
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
Analog Tuner
Auto Channel
Setting
Auto Scan
Select your country and then wait for the recorder to
auto tune into channels in your area. After auto scan
has finished, the channel mapping screen appears
showing which channels have been assigned to
which programme numbers. You can skip unwanted
channels using the Manual CH Setting option below.
Press HOME MENU to exit the channel mapping
screen.
Download from
TV
If your TV supports this feature you can download all
the channels that your TV is tuned to via the SCART
input. Select your country and then wait for the
download to complete. After the download is
complete, the channel mapping screen appears, as
above.
See also the operating instructions that came with
your TV for more information.
Manual CH Setting Next Screen
Proceed to the next screen if you need to adjust any
of the settings made by auto tuning. Select your
country, then proceed to the manual channel setting
screen:
• Change channel presets using the Smart Jog.
• To skip the displayed channel (because there is no
station assigned to that channel), change the Skip
setting to On.
• Set the CH SYSTEM setting to match the channel
system of your country or region.
• Set the CHANNEL setting to the channel you want
to assign to the current channel preset.
• To manually fine tune the channel, change the AFT
setting to Off then adjust the Level setting.
• Set the Sound System setting to match the sound
system of your region.
• The Name field allows you to input a name of up to
five characters for the current channel preset.
• If the currently selected channel is scrambled
requiring a decoder connected to the AV2 (INPUT 1/
DECODER), set the Decoder setting to On.
Channel Swapping Next Screen
Proceed to the next screen to swap channel
assignments of different presets so that you can
group together presets that naturally go together.
Select two presets to swap then press ENTER.
130
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
Video In/Out
Input Colour
System
Next Screen
Proceed to the next screen to set the input colour
system for the external input and the built-in TV
tuner. Use the Smart Jog or INPUT SELECT buttons
to change the preset or external input. On the default
Auto setting the recorder can generally correctly
detect whether the input signal is PAL, SECAM, 3.58
NTSC or PAL-60, but in some cases you may have to
set it manually if the picture is displayed incorrectly.
• Input Colour System cannot be set when the recorder is in D.TV mode.
• See also About the input colour system on page 141 for more information on this setting.
Component Video Interlace •
Out
Select if your monitor/TV is not compatible with
progressive-scan video.
Progressive
Select if your monitor/TV is progressive-scan
compatible. Check the operating instructions that
came with your monitor/TV if you’re not sure.
• For Component Video Out to be effective, the AV1 Out setting (see below) must be set to something other than
RGB.
• If your TV is incompatible with progressive scan video and you select Progressive, you will not be able to see any
picture at all. In this case, press ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE while holding down the ꢄ (Stop) button on the front panel to
switch to Interlace (this also switches Screen Resolution on page 138 to the default setting).
• When the HDMI signal is output, no video is output from the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT.
AV1 Out
Video •
S-Video
RGB
Sets the AV1 (RGB)-TV SCART output to standard
composite video (compatible with all TVs).
Sets the AV1 (RGB)-TV SCART output to S-video.
Recommended if you are using a long SCART cable.
Sets the AV1 (RGB)-TV SCART output to RGB. Good
quality but check your TV for compatibility. Note that
on this setting signals from the built-in tuner and
from external inputs is not output when the recorder
is in TV mode.
• If you choose a setting that is incompatible with your TV you may not be able to see any picture at all. In this case
either switch off and reconnect using the supplied video cable, or reset the recorder (see Resetting the recorder on
page 157).
• The Component Video Out setting (see above) has no effect when AV1 Out is set to RGB.
• When the HDMI signal is output, the AV1 Out outputs the composite video signal even when it is set to RGB.
131
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Video •
Explanation
AV2/L1 In
Sets the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART input to
standard composite video.
S-Video
RGB
Sets the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART input to
S-video.
Sets the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART input to
RGB.
Decoder
Use this setting if you connected a decoder to the
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART connector. For
scrambled channels, make sure that the channel
Decoder setting is set to On. (See Manual CH Setting
on page 130.)
NTSC on PAL TV
On •
Off
NTSC discs will play correctly on PAL-only TVs.
Use if your TV is already NTSC-compatible.
Many recent PAL TVs are compatible with NTSC input and so this setting can be switched off. Check the operating
instructions that came with your TV. See also About NTSC on PAL TV on page 141 for related information.
Audio In
NICAM Select
NICAM •
Record the NICAM audio in a NICAM broadcast.
Regular Audio
Record the non-NICAM audio in a NICAM broadcast.
(You can still switch the audio to record using the
AUDIO button before recording.)
Analog Tuner Level Normal •
Compression
Standard setting.
Use if the audio level from the built-in tuner is
excessive, causing distortion.
External Audio
Stereo •
Bilingual
Select if the audio from the currently selected
external input is standard stereo.
Select if each channel carries a separate soundtrack.
When the external audio is from the DV input, an audio subcode channel within the DV audio tells the recorder
whether the audio is stereo or bilingual. This has priority over the setting you make here.
Bilingual Recording A/L •
Record the left (A) channel of a bilingual source
when recording to HDD with HDD Recording Format
set to Video Mode On, to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or
DVD+R/+RW or in LPCM mode, from an external
source.
B/R
As above, but for right (B) channel recording.
When recording bilingual audio to DVD in VR mode (except in LPCM mode), or to HDD with HDD Recording Format
set to Video Mode Off (except in LPCM mode), both audio channels are recorded and you can switch to the one you
want on playback.
132
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
DV Input
Stereo 1 •
Select to use the ‘live’ audio track (recorded during
the video shoot) from a camcorder that supports two
stereo audio tracks.
Stereo 2
Mix
Select to use the overdubbed audio track from a
camcorder that supports two stereo audio tracks.
Select one of the three settings to use a mix of the
two stereo audio tracks.
Audio Out
Dolby Digital Out
Dolby Digital •
Output a Dolby Digital signal when a Dolby Digital
source is being played.
Dolby Digital ꢄ Convert Dolby Digital sources to Linear PCM output.
PCM
On •
Off
Use if your connected equipment doesn’t have a
Dolby Digital decoder.
DTS Out
Output a DTS signal when a DTS source is being
played.
Switch off the digital output when a DTS source is
being played. Use when your connected equipment
doesn’t have a DTS decoder. In this case, use the
analog audio outputs.
96 kHz PCM Out
MPEG Out
96 kHz ꢄ 48 kHz • Convert 96 kHz digital audio sources to 48 kHz
output. Use if your connected equipment doesn’t
support 96 kHz sampling rate.
96 kHz
Output 96 kHz digital audio when a 96 kHz source is
being played.
MPEG
Output an MPEG audio signal when a source using
MPEG audio is being played.
MPEG ꢄ PCM •
Convert sources with MPEG audio to Linear PCM
output. Use if your connected equipment doesn’t
have an MPEG audio decoder.
Audio DRC
On
Switches on Audio DRC (Dynamic Range Control).
Use when listening to Dolby Digital material at low
volume.
Off •
Switches off Audio DRC.
Audio DRC is not effective when listening via the digital output when the Dolby Digital Out setting is set to Dolby
Digital.
133
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
Language
OSD Language
English •
Sets the language of the on-screen displays to
English.
available languages Choose from the languages displayed for the on-
screen displays.
On Screen Display and D.TV Language will both reflect this setting.
Audio Language
English •
Sets the default audio language for DVD-Video
playback to English.
available languages Choose from the languages displayed to set the
default audio language for DVD-Video playback.
Other
Select to set the default audio language to
something other than the ones listed. See Selecting
other languages for language options on page 142.
Discs do not necessarily have audio in your selected language. Also, some discs override the Audio Language
preference.
Subtitle Language English •
Sets the default subtitle language for DVD-Video
playback to English.
available languages Choose from the languages displayed to set the
default subtitle language for DVD-Video playback.
Other
Select to set the default subtitle language to
something other than the ones listed. See Selecting
other languages for language options on page 142.
Discs do not necessarily have subtitles in your selected menu language. Also, some discs override the Subtitle
Language preference.
Auto Language
On •
On this setting:
• DVD-Video discs whose main audio track is in your
default language will play using that language,
without subtitles.
• Discs whose main audio track is not in your default
language but that have a subtitle track in your default
language will play the original audio track with
subtitles.
Off
Select to play DVD-Video discs according to your
audio and subtitle language preferences.
For Auto Language to be effective, the Audio Language and Subtitle Language options must be set to the same
language.
134
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
DVD Menu
Language
w/Subtitle
Language •
Sets the language of DVD-Video menus to the same
as that set for the subtitle language.
English
Sets the language of DVD-Video menus to English.
available languages Choose from the displayed languages to set the
default language for DVD-Video menus.
Other
Select to set the DVD menu language to something
other than the ones listed. See Selecting other
languages for language options on page 142.
Discs do not necessarily have menus in your selected menu language.
Subtitle Display
On •
Select to have discs display subtitles according to
your Subtitle Language and Auto Language
preferences.
Off
Select to switch off subtitle display.
Assist Subtitle
Select to display special additional assistive
subtitles, where available.
Some discs may override these settings.
Recording
Manual Recording On (go to setup) All the standard recording modes, plus MN1 to
MN32, LPCM and XP+ modes can be set.
Off •
Justthestandardrecordingmodes(XP,SP,LP, EP,SLP
and SEP) can be set.
See also Manual recording modes on page 145 for detailed information on manual recording levels.
Optimized Rec
On
The recording quality of timer recordings is
automatically adjusted to fit on to the selected media
if it will not fit at the selected quality setting. If the
recording will not fit even at MN1(MN4 for DVD+R/
+RW), then the recording will be made to the HDD
in the original quality selected.
Off •
When a timer recording is set that won’t fit on to the
selected media, the recording starts but is cut off
when no more recording is possible.
Optimized Rec will only compensate for the next scheduled timer recording if more than one is set. It cannot be
used together with VPS/PDC.
Subtitle Recording On
The selected subtitle language is recorded with the
D.TV timer recording.
Off •
No subtitles are recorded with D.TV timer recordings.
135
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
Set Thumbnail
0 seconds •
Sets the default thumbnail picture in the Disc
Navigator to the first frame of the title.
30 seconds
3 minutes
On •
Sets the default thumbnail picture to 30 seconds into
the title.
Sets the default thumbnail picture to three minutes
into the title.
Auto Chapter
(HDD/VR)
When recording to the HDD or in VR mode to a DVD,
chapter marks are added at the black screen
between commercials and main programming.
When recording in DV, chapter marks can be
changed by date/time.
Off
Automatic chapter marking is switched off.
Automatic chapter marking is switched off.
Auto Chapter
(Video)
No Separation
10 minutes •
When recording in Video mode, chapter markers are
inserted every 10 minutes.
15 minutes
Chapter markers are inserted every 15 minutes.
This settings applies to recording or real-time copying to Video mode DVD-R/-RW discs.
Auto Chapter
(DVD+R/+RW)
No Separation
10 minutes •
Automatic chapter marking is switched off.
When recording in DVD+R/+RW or in real-time
copying, chapter markers are inserted every 10 minutes.
15 minutes
Chapter markers are inserted every 15 minutes.
HDD Recording
Format
Video Mode Off Recordings made to the HDD are made in VR mode.
Use this setting if you don’t need to transfer the
recording later to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or
DVD+R/+RW.
Video Mode On • Recordings made to the HDD are compatible with
Video mode recordings. This setting is convenient if
you want to transfer the recording to a DVD-R/-RW
(Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW as high-speed copy
can be used.
• When Video Mode On is used, you must select the audio channel you want to record when recording a bilingual
broadcast. On the Video Mode Off setting, both channels will be recorded and you can switch between them on
playback. See also Bilingual Recording on page 132.
• When the recording mode is set to XP+, you cannot change HDD Recording Format.
136
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
Playback
TV Screen Size
4:3 (Letter Box)
Select if you have a standard 4:3 TV and prefer the
letter box format presentation for widescreen
material.
4:3 (Pan & Scan) Select if you have a standard 4:3 TV and prefer the
pan and scan presentation for widescreen material.
16:9 •
Select if you have a widescreen 16:9 TV. Your TV
settings determine how 4:3 material will look.
Selecting 4:3 (Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan) does not guarantee that all video material will be presented in that
format as some discs override this setting.
Still Picture
Field
Produces a stable, generally shake-free image.
Produces sharp image, but may be prone to shake.
Frame
Auto •
Generates a generally less sharp but more stable still
image.
Seamless Playback On
Off •
Playback is smooth, but with a trade-off against the
accuracy of the edit points.
You may notice momentary interruption at edited
points during playback of a VR mode Play List.
This setting applies to HDD, DVD-R/-RW (VR) and DVD-RAM playback.
Angle Indicator
On •
A camera icon appears on-screen during multi-angle
scenes on a DVD-Video disc.
Off
Nothing is indicated on-screen when a multi-angle
scene is showing.
Parental Lock
Set Password /
Change Password
Next Screen
If no password has yet been set, enter a four digit
number to become your password. If you want to
change the password, first enter your old password,
then enter a new one.
DVD Playback
D.TV Age Limit
Next Screen
Next Screen
From this screen, first enter your password and then
set a parental lock level for playback of DVDs with
parental level coding.
Use this screen to enter an age limit for D.TV
programmes. Programmes that are broadcast with
age suitability guidelines that fall above the age set
here will require the correct password to be entered
before the channel can be viewed.
You must also enter your password in order to
change the age limit setting.
This setting is only applicable when the country is set to France, Denmark, Finland or Sweden.
137
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Explanation
HDMI Output (only available when an HDMI device is connected)
Screen Resolution
1920 x 1080p
1920 x 1080i
1280 x 720p
Constant 1920 x 1080p output.
Constant 1920 x 1080i output.
Constant 1280 x 720p output.
720 x 576p
(720 x 480p)
Constant 720 x 576p output (when setting the Input
Line System to 525 System, video is output in 720 x
480p).
720 x 576i
(720 x 480i)
Constant 720 x 576i output (when setting the Input
Line System to 525 System, video is output in 720 x
480i).
• If you choose a setting that is incompatible with your TV you may not be able to see any picture at all. In this
case, press ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE while holding down the ꢄ (Stop) button on the front panel to switch the setting (this
also switches Component Video Out on page 131 to the default setting).
• If you have the Colour set to YCbCr 4:2:2, you cannot select 720 x 576i (720 x 480i).
4:3 Video Output
Full
Select if your HDMI TV allows you to change the
aspect ratio.
Normal
Select if your HDMI TV does not allow you to change
the aspect ratio. 4:3 video will be shown with bars on
each side.
Colour
RGB (0–255)
RGB (16–235)
YCbCr 4:2:2
Use if colours are weak and black appears to ‘float’
on the RGB (16–235) setting.
Use this setting if colours appear overly rich and the
black too deep on the RGB (0–255) setting.
The video signal is output as a 10-bit YCbCr 4:2:2
component signal. This is the standard setting for
HDMI-compatible devices.
YCbCr 4:4:4
The video signal is output as a 8-bit YCbCr 4:4:4
component signal.
• Depending on the connected device some settings may not be available.
• When a DVI device is connected, the YCbCr 4:2:2 and YCbCr 4:4:4 options are not available.
• You cannot choose YCbCr 4:2:2 when the Screen Resolution is set to 720 x 576i (720 x 480i).
Audio Output
Auto •
Dolby Digital, MPEG and DTS sources are output as
a bitstream signal. However, depending on the
Audio Out setting, number of audio channels, and
the HDMI-connected device, Linear PCM audio may
be output.
PCM
All audio signals are converted to Linear PCM
(except DTS).
Bitstream Priority Select if the connected device is compatible with
bitstream audio.
This setting is not available when a DVI device is connected.
138
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options
Options
Explanation
On Screen Display On •
The recorder displays operation displays (Stop, Play,
etc.) on-screen.
Off
Switches off the on-screen operation displays.
Front Panel Display On •
The time is shown in the front panel display when the
recorder is in standby.
Off
The front panel display is switched off in standby.
Remote Control
Mode
Recorder 1–3
If you are using more than one recorder in the same
(default: Recorder 1) room, set them to different IDs. This setting sets the
recorder ID; to change the remote controller ID,
press and hold RETURN/EXIT then press 1, 2 or 3 to
set. The remote will only control a recorder with the
same ID.
AV. Link
This Recorder
Only •
Signals received through the AV input when the
recorder is in standby are not passed through to the
AV output.
Pass Through
Signals received when in standby are passed though
to the output for connected devices. (Note that
during EPG data download, the EPG data is not
passed through.)
When set to Pass Through, make sure to set Power Save (page 127) to Off.
DivX VOD
Registration Code Use to display the recorder’s DivX registration code.
See DivX video compatibility on page 10 and DivX®
VOD content on page 11.
Set Preview
(HDD only)
Quick Preview • When in the Disc Navigator, the thumbnail video
plays short excerpts from throughout the selected
title. (Note that edited titles that will play normally
from the beginning.)
Normal
The thumbnail video plays from the beginning of the
title.
CI Information
Next Screen
This option displays a menu of CI card functions.
Consult your service provider for more information
on the functions available.
Software Update
Next Screen
The Software Update function can check for and
download updated system software for the digital
tuner. See Using Software Update (Digital tuner) on
page 142.
139
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Setting
Options 2
USB
Options
Explanation
Restart USB
Device
If the connected USB device does not respond to the
recorder, try using this option to restart it. If the
device still does not work properly try switching it off
then back on, and/or disconnecting then
reconnecting the USB cable.
Confirm Printer
TV’s Tuner
Use this option to confirm the make and model of the
printer connected to the recorder (does not work with
all printers).
Pause Live TV
Allows you to use the Pause Live TV feature with an
AV Link-compatible TV connected by SCART cable.
Recorder’s
Tuner •
Allows you to use Pause Live TV with this recorder’s
internal TV tuner.
See also Pause Live TV on page 66 for more information on this setting.
HDD Sleep Mode
Proceed
Puts the HDD to sleep. Using this feature when
playing DVDs or CDs allows you to reduce noise
produced by the unit, resulting in improved sound
quality. When you wake the HDD back up it will take
a few seconds to load.
The HDD can be taken out of Sleep Mode by any
number of actions, including:
• Turning the power off and on again.
• Pressing the HDD/DVD button and choosing the
HDD.
• When a timer recording begins.
• When you try and make any changes to system
settings.
140
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
About NTSC on PAL TV
Additional information about the
TV system settings
Depending on the Input Line System setting
and the NTSC on PAL TV setting, the signal
format output when the recorder is stopped
varies as shown in the table below.
About the input line system
This recorder is compatible with PAL,
SECAM, 3.58 NTSC and PAL-60 TV systems.
The Input Line System and Input Colour
System settings determine how the recorder
treats incoming video signals from an
external input.
Output
when
stopped
Input Line
System
NTSC on PAL
TV
625 System
Off
On
Off
On
PAL
Please note the following points when
changing the input line system:
PAL
• When the current input is a built-in tuner
channel preset, changing the input line
system will usually also affect the input
line system of the AV2 (INPUT 1/
525 System
NTSC
PAL–60
About the input colour system
The available options of the Input Colour
System setting depend on the Input Line
System setting. The table below shows the
different options available.
DECODER) input. However if the AV2/L1
In setting is set to Decoder, then the L2
input is affected instead.
• If, when the Input Line System setting is
changed, the screen goes blank (due to
incompatibility with your TV), you can
switch back by pressing and holding the
front panel ꢄ (Stop) button then
pressing INPUT SELECT (also front
panel) while the recorder is stopped.
Input Line
System
Built-in
analog tuner input
External
625 System
Auto
PAL
Auto
PAL
• When you switch the Input Line System
setting the Copy List is erased. If you
switch the setting using the ꢄ (Stop)
button and INPUT SELECT buttons as
described above, there is no
SECAM
n/a
SECAM
Auto
525 System
3.58 NTSC
PAL–60
confirmation, so please use with care.
• You can’t mix recordings of different TV
line systems on the same disc.
Additional information about
component video output
• When you change this setting, the Input
Colour System setting also changes
(see below).
If you switch the Component Video Out
setting to Progressive when using a TV that
is not compatible with progressive-scan
video, you will not be able to see anything
displayed on your TV. If this happens, press
and hold the ꢄ (Stop) button on the front
panel, then press ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE. This will
set the recorder’s video output back to
Interlace.
141
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Initial Setup menu
16
Manual Update
Selecting other languages
for language options
Select Manual Update to check for updated
software immediately. If new software is
found then it is automatically downloaded
and installed. The new software will take
effect the next time the recorder is powered
on.
ENTER
1
Select ‘Other’ from the
language list.
If for some reason the new software could
not be downloaded successfully, a dialog
box informs you of the error. Press HOME
MENU to exit or RETURN/EXIT to return to
the previous screen.
This option appears in the settings for DVD
Menu Language, Audio Language, and
Subtitle Language.
ENTER
Note that channel information may be
erased when software update is used, and
that timer recording will not work during the
update.
2
Select the language you
want.
Initial Setup
Basic
OSD DVD Menu Language
To cancel manual update before it has
completed, press HOME MENU.
Digital Tuner
Analogue Tuner
Video In/Out
Audio In
Audi
Language
English
Subt
0
1
4
Number
Auto
5
DVD
Subt
Language
Auto Update
Language
Recording
By default, the Auto Update option is On,
which means that periodically the recorder
will check for and update the digital tuner
software if it’s available. We recommend
that you leave this option On.
• Select by language name: Use the ꢃ/ꢀ
buttons to change the language.
• Select by code number: Press ꢂ then
use the number buttons to enter the
four-digit language code.
If new software is found and successfully
downloaded, the recorder automatically
scans for new digital channels, informing
you if any are found (this is the equivalent of
using the Add New Channel option, found in
the Digital Tuner section of the Initial Setup
menu).
See Language code list on page 154 for a list
of available languages and corresponding
codes.
Using Software Update
(Digital tuner)
Technical Information
This displays the current hardware and
software version numbers of the digital
tuner.
The Software Update function can keep the
built-in digital tuner up to date with the latest
system software. You can either check for
updates manually, or have the recorder do it
automatically at regular intervals.
Access the Software Update screen from the
Options menu.
There are three options available: Manual
Update, Auto Update and Technical
Information.
142
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Chapter 17
Additional information
Maker
Code
Setting up the remote to
control your TV
Alba
66
Bush
76
You can use the supplied remote to control
your TV. To be able to use this feature you
first have to program the remote with a
maker code from the table below.
Fisher
61, 65
77
Fujitsu
Funai
67
Goldstar
Grandiente
Grundig
Hitachi
ITT
79
1
Press and hold down the CLEAR
87
button, then enter the maker code for
your TV.
51, 82
56, 60, 83, 86
70
See the table on the following page for the
list of maker codes. If there is more than one
code given for your make, input the first one
in the list.
• If the maker’s name of your TV doesn’t
appear in the table below, you will not be
able to use this remote to control your
TV.
Mitsubishi
Nokia
59
53, 81
58, 72
57, 85, 89
50, 80
68
Panasonic
Philips
Pioneer
RCA
Salora
Samsung
Sanyo
71
2
Press ꢂ to check that the remote
73, 75
74
works with your TV.
If the remote is set up correctly, the TV
should switch on/off. If it doesn’t and there is
another code given for your maker, repeat
step 1 with a new code.
Sei
78
Sharp
52
Sony
54
Tandy
69
Telefunken
Thomson
Toshiba
JVC
64
Using the TV remote control
buttons
The table below shows how to use this
remote control with your TV.
62, 89
55
63
Button
What it does
ꢂ
Press to switch the TV on/off
(standby)
INPUT SELECT Press to change the TV’s video
input
VOLUME +/– Use to adjust the TV volume
CHANNEL +/– Use to change TV channels
143
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Minimum copying times
The table below shows the minimum HDD to DVD copying time for one hour of video.
1
Please note that not all discs are compatible with high-speed copying. Check with the disc
manufacturer for compatibility.
Rec mode
SEP
SLP
EP
LP
SP
XP
10 h
8 h
6 h
4 h
2 h
1 h
DVD disc type
DVD-R / 1x
DVD-RW / 1x
1x
2x
6 mins.
3 mins.
7.5 mins.
4 mins.
10 mins.
5 mins.
15 mins.
7.5 mins.
30 mins.
15 mins.
60 mins.
30 mins.
DVD-RW / 2x
DVD-R DL
DVD-RAM / 2x
DVD+R / 2.4x
DVD+RW / 2.4x
DVD+R DL
2.4x
3x
*1
*1
*1
6.3 mins.
5 mins.
12.5 mins.
10 mins.
25 mins.
20 mins.
DVD-RAM / 3x
DVD-RAM / 5x
2 mins.
2.5 mins.
3.5 mins.
DVD-R / 4x
DVD-RW / 4x
DVD+R / 4x
DVD+RW / 4x
4x
1.5 mins.*1
2 mins.*1
2.5 mins.*1
4 mins.
3 mins.
7.5 mins.
5.5 mins.
15 mins.
11 mins.
DVD-R / 8x / 16x
DVD+R / 8x / 16x
DVD-RW / 6x
6x 1.25 mins.*1 1.6 mins.*1
2.2 mins.*1
DVD+RW / 8x
Note that all times in the above table are approximate. Also that actual copy speed varies with the part of the disc
being recorded.
*1 Titles recorded on DVD+R/+RW in SEP, SLP or EP modes cannot be high-speed copied.
Note
1 Depending on the disc, the copy speed may be reduced (for example, although a 6x disc is used, the copy may
be made at 2x speed).
144
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Manual recording modes
17
The table below shows the approximate recording times for different DVD types in each
manual recording mode, as well as the standard recording mode equivalents. For recording
time on the HDD, see Specifications on page 158.
Rec. time*1
Resolution*2
Single-Layer
DVD:
DVD-R/-RW
DVD+R/+RW
DVD-RAM
Video mode On (HDD)
Video mode (DVD-R/-RW)
DVD+R/+RW
Video mode (DVD-R DL)
DVD+R DL
Dual-Layer
DVD:
DVD-R DL
DVD+R DL
Video mode Off (HDD)
VR mode (DVD-R/-RW)
DVD-RAM
VR mode (DVD-R DL)
Level
MN 1 *3,4
MN 2 *3,4
MN 3 *3,4
MN 4 *4
MN 5 *4
MN 6 *4
MN 7
802 mins. 1440 mins.
720 mins. 1292 mins.
600 mins. 1077 mins.
480 mins. 861 mins.
420 mins. 754 mins.
360 mins. 646 mins.
SEP
SLP
352 x 240 /
352 x 288
352 x 240 /
352 x 288
EP
LP
300 mins. 538 mins.
270 mins. 484 mins.
240 mins. 431 mins.
230 mins. 413 mins.
220 mins. 395 mins.
210 mins. 377 mins.
200 mins. 359 mins.
190 mins. 341 mins.
180 mins. 323 mins.
170 mins. 305 mins.
160 mins. 287 mins.
150 mins. 269 mins.
140 mins. 251 mins.
130 mins. 233 mins.
120 mins. 215 mins.
110 mins. 197 mins.
105 mins. 188 mins.
100 mins. 179 mins.
95 mins. 170 mins.
90 mins. 161 mins.
85 mins. 153 mins.
80 mins. 144 mins.
75 mins. 135 mins.
70 mins. 126 mins.
65 mins. 117 mins.
61 mins. 111 mins.
61 mins. 111 mins.
352 x 480 /
352 x 576
352 x 480 /
352 x 576
MN 8
MN 9
480 x 480 /
480 x 576
MN 10
MN 11
MN 12
MN 13
MN 14
MN 15
MN 16
MN 17
MN 18
MN 19
MN 20
MN 21
MN 22
MN 23
MN 24
MN 25
MN 26
MN 27
MN 28
MN 29
MN 30
MN 31
MN 32
LPCM
544 x 480 /
544 x 576
720 x 480 /
720 x 576
SP
720 x 480 /
720 x 576
XP
XP+*5
--- mins.
--- mins.
*1 Recording time may be slightly shorter for certain disc types or recording modes.
*2 The first figure refers to when the Input Line System is set to 525 System; the second when set to 625 System.
*3 Modes MN1 to MN3 not available when using DVD+R/+RW.
*4 Titles recorded at MN6 or lower cannot be high-speed copied to DVD+R/+RW.
*5 XP+ mode is available for HDD recordings only. If set for a DVD recording, the DVD will be automatically recorded
in MN32 mode.
145
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
•
Levels separated by a bold line show where there is a noticeable change in picture quality.
•
Audio recording in all manual recording modes is in Dolby Digital 2 ch format, except for LPCM mode, which is
in Linear PCM format.
• See also Recording on page 59.
Troubleshooting
Incorrect operation is often mistaken for trouble and malfunction. If you think there is
something wrong with this component, please check the points below. Sometimes the
trouble may lie in another component. Investigate the other components and electrical
appliances being used. If the trouble cannot be rectified even after checking the points below,
ask your nearest Pioneer authorized service center or your dealer to carry out repair work.
General
Problem
Remedy
The disc is
• Check that the disc is not an incompatible format disc (page 7).
automatically ejected • Check that the disc is loaded properly (aligned in disc tray and label-
after closing the disc
tray
side up).
• Take out the disc and clean it (page 156).
• Check that the disc has a region code compatible with the recorder.
Can’t eject a disc
Can’t play a disc
• Turn off the power to this device and press and hold ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE
on the front of the unit for more than three seconds.
• Check that the disc is a compatible format disc (page 7).
• Take out the disc and clean it (page 156).
• Check that the disc is loaded properly (aligned in disc tray and label-
side up).
• Press HDD/DVD to select the DVD.
• There may be condensation in the recorder. Leave the recorder for
an hour or so for the condensation to evaporate.
• During HDD recording, you can’t play discs that are recorded with a
Line System different to the current recorder setting.
• DVD+R/+RW discs recorded using another recorder with copy-
once protected recordings will not play in this recorder.
Can’t record a disc
• Check that the disc is not an incompatible format disc (page 7).
• Some DVD-RAM discs are not recordable until they have been
initialized (page 72). This can take up to an hour.
Remote control does
not work
• If you connected this recorder to another Pioneer product using the
CONTROL IN jack, point the remote control at the other component to
use (page 14).
• Set the remote control to the same ID number as the recorder
(page 139). (When the batteries run down, the remote mode is
automatically reset to Recorder1.)
• Use the remote within its operating range (page 6).
• Replace the batteries (page 6).
All settings are reset
• If the recorder is unplugged (or there is a power failure) while the
recorder is on, all the settings will be lost.
• Make sure that you switch the recorder into standby before
unplugging the power cord.
146
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Problem
Remedy
No picture
• Check that everything is connected properly (page 14).
• Check that the connected TV and/or the AV amp/receiver is set to
the correct input.
• The recorder may be set to progressive scan with an incompatible
TV. Reset to interlace by pressing and holding the front panel ꢄ (Stop)
button then pressing ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE.
•
If you are using an indoor antenna that requires power, make sure that
Aerial Power in the Initial Setup menu is set to On or Auto (page 129).
• If the aerial/antenna is not connected properly, or if it is shorted, the
Aerial Power setting will revert to Off automatically. Check the aerial
connection and try making the setting again.
• When the HDMI signal is output, no video is output from the
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT.
No sound or sound is
distorted
• Make sure that the amp/receiver or TV is set to the correct input and
the volume turned up.
• There is no sound when the picture is paused, or during scanning or
slow motion play. Press ꢃ PLAY to resume regular playback.
• DTS discs can only be played if this recorder is connected to a DTS
decoder or DTS compatible amp/receiver. If you have connected a
suitable decoder, also make sure that the Initial Setup > Audio Out >
DTS Out setting is On.
• Some 96 kHz discs do not output audio through the digital jack. In
this case, switch the input of your amp/receiver to analog.
• Check the audio cable connections (page 14).
• If the sound is distorted, try cleaning the cable plugs.
Cannot switch a
bilingual programme
• During real-time copying it is not possible to switch audio channels.
The main and sub channels are both output.
The picture from the
external input is
distorted
• If the video signal from the external component is copy-protected,
you cannot connect via this recorder. Connect the component directly
to your TV.
The picture is distorted • Change the Input Line System setting (page 141). (You can also
change it by pressing the ꢄ (Stop) button and INPUT SELECT on the
front panel simultaneously with the recorder stopped.)
Screen is stretched
vertically or
• Make sure that the TV Screen Size setting (page 137) is correct for
the kind of TV you have (see also page 155).
horizontally
• If you have a widescreen TV, check its aspect ratio settings.
• This recorder’s input switches into wide mode automatically
according to the input signal. When the unit connected is not
compatible with VIDEO ID-1 (widescreen signalling), set the
connected component to output 4:3 aspect ratio (standard) video.
Audio/subtitle
language cannot be
changed
• Note that audio and subtitle languages cannot be changed
during the recording of a digital broadcast.
• You can only use the audio track and subtitles for the language that
were selected at the time of recording a digital broadcast. The audio
track and subtitles cannot be changed to other languages.
147
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Problem
Remedy
Can’t play a disc
recorded using this
recorder on another
player
• If the disc was recorded in DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R,
make sure that it’s finalized (page 71).
• Some players will not play recordable DVD discs, even when
recorded in DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R and finalized.
• If the disc was recorded in VR mode, the other player must be
specifically RW compatible in order to play it (page 7).
• Discs recorded with copy-once material cannot be played on non-
CPRM compatible players (page 61).
• DVD+RW discs containing only a small amount of recorded
material may not play on other players. Finalize the disc and try again.
During playback the
picture is dark or
distorted
• When a copy-protected disc is played via a VCR, the picture will not
display correctly. Connect the recorder directly to your TV.
Recorded contents are • Change the recording mode to XP/SP.
not clear or artefacts
appear in areas of flat
colour (due to MPEG
compression; also
known as block noise)
Can’t record or does
• Check that there is some remaining blank space on the DVD/HDD.
not record successfully • For a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R, check that the disc isn’t
already finalized.
• Check the limits on the number of titles and chapters on a disc:
– HDD: 999 titles
– VR mode: 99 titles, 999 chapters per disc
– Video mode disc: 99 titles per disc, 99 chapters per title
– DVD+R/+RW: 49 titles per disc, 99 chapters per title (max 254
chapters per disc)
• Check that the source you are trying to record is not copy protected.
• For a VR formatted disc, check that the disc isn’t locked (page 121).
• Check that you are recording with the same TV system (PAL, NTSC,
etc.) as the disc has already been recorded in. All recordings on a disc
must be in the same TV system. When recording to the HDD, it is also
necessary to set the Input Line System setting to match what you want
to record (page 141).
• The power may have failed during recording.
Timer programme
doesn’t record
successfully
• When setting the recording channel, make sure you set the
recorder’s built-in TV tuner, not the TV’s built-in tuner.
• When recording to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW,
programmes that are copy-once protected cannot be recorded. Use a
VR mode formatted disc for copy-once material (page 61).
• Two timer programmes may have overlapped, in which case only the
earlier one will record completely.
• The power may have failed during recording.
148
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Problem
Remedy
After briefly
• A backup battery inside the recorder keeps the clock and other
unplugging or after a settings from being reset when there is no power to the recorder. After
power failure the front unplugging or a power failure, the battery keeps all settings for a
panel display shows
‘--:--’
period of several minutes. Reset the clock and other recorder settings
to use the recorder again.
Front panel display
shows ‘LOCKED’ when
a button is pressed
• The Child Lock is on; turn off in order to use the recorder (page 69).
Can’t use One Touch
Copy (HDD to DVD)
• Make sure that there is a recordable DVD-R/-RW loaded with some
free space for recording and fewer than 99 titles already on the disc.
Also make sure that for a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or a DVD+R, the
disc isn’t finalized.
• Make sure there is a recordable DVD+R/+RW loaded with some
free space for recording and fewer than 49 titles already on the disc.
• If you delete a title from a DVD+R/+RW disc, the number of
remaining recordable titles may not decrease.
• Further recording is not possible on a finalized DVD+R. Check that
there isn’t a disc menu on the disc you’re trying to use.
• If the title currently playing contains material that is copy-once
protected, One Touch Copy will not work.
• If the currently playing HDD content was recorded in XP+ mode, the
One Touch Copy feature can’t be used.
• One Touch Copy can’t be used for titles over eight hours long when
copying to DVD+R/+RW (though you can use a DVD+R DL).
• One Touch Copy can’t be used for MN1 to MN6, SEP, SLP or EP titles
when copying to DVD+R/+RW.
• One Touch Copy doesn’t work if the recorder is already recording to
DVD.
Can’t use One Touch
Copy (DVD to HDD)
• Make sure that there is space available on the HDD and that there
are fewer than 999 titles on the HDD.
• One Touch Copy doesn’t work if the recorder is already recording to
the HDD.
The device connected • Check that the device is compatible with this recorder (page 22).
to the USB port is not • Use a USB cable less than 5 m in length.
recognized
• Check that the USB cable is inserted fully.
• Check that the USB device is powered on.
• Try switching this recorder into standby mode and then back on.
• Try using the Restart USB Device option from the Initial Setup
menu (page 140).
• If several USB devices (camera, USB memory, card reader, etc.) are
connected at the same time, it’s possible that only the first device
connected to this recorder will be recognized.
File names are not
displayed properly.
• Files names that do not conform to the ISO8859-1 standard may not
display correctly on this unit.
149
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
HDMI
Problem
Remedy
The connected HDMI or • Try disconnecting then reconnecting the HDMI cable (while the
DVI device does not
display any picture
(and the front panel
HDMI indicator does
not light)
power of both components is on).
• Try switching the power of the HDMI/DVI device off then back on.
• Try switching off the HDMI/DVI device and this recorder. Next,
switch on the HDMI/DVI device and leave it for around 30 seconds,
then switch on this recorder.
• When you connect an HDMI-compatible device make sure of the
following:
– The connected device’s video input is set correctly for this unit.
– The cable you’re using is fully HDMI-compliant. Using a non-
standard cable may result in no picture being output.
– Don’t use several HDMI cables connected together. Use a single
cable to connect devices together.
•
When you connect a DVI-compatible device make sure of the following:
– The connected device’s video input is set correctly for this unit.
– The DVI terminal on the connected device is HDCP-compatible.
– The connected device is compatible with NTSC (720 x 480i/p,
1280 x 720p, 1920 x 1080i/p) and PAL (720 x 576i/p, 1280 x 720p, 1920 x
1080i/p) video input.
• If the recorder’s internal HDD is damaged or broken, there will be no
HDMI output.
• Not all HDCP-compatible DVI devices will work with this recorder.
No video from the
HDMI output
• If you choose a setting that is incompatible with your TV you may not
be able to see any picture at all. In this case, press ꢁ OPEN/CLOSE
while holding down the ꢄ (Stop) button on the front panel to switch
the setting (this also switches Component Video Out on page 131 to
the default setting).
There’s no sound from • There is no sound when using a DVI terminal.
the connected HDMI or • Some HDMI-compatible devices do not output sound (check with
DVI device
the manual that came with the connected device).
If the unit does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricity, disconnect
the power plug from the outlet and insert again to return to normal operating conditions.
If the picture freezes and the front panel and remote control
buttons stop working
• Press ꢄ (Stop) then try restarting
STANDBY/ON
playback.
• Press the front panel ꢂ STANDBY/ON
button to switch the power off, then
HDD/DVD
COPY
OPEN/CLOSE
switch back on and restart playback. If
the power fails to switch off, press and
hold ꢂ STANDBY/ON for five seconds
until the power switches off.
A.TV
D.TV
PLTV
DivX
COMMON INTERFACE
STANDBY/ON
DV IN
USB
STOP REC
INPUT
SELECT
CH
150
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
On-screen displays
17
The table below shows a list of error messages that you may encounter when using the
recorder and an explanation of their meaning.
Message
Explanation/Action
• Initializing disc. Please wait a
moment.
When you load a blank DVD-RW or DVD+RW disc,
the recorder automatically initializes it.
• Incompatible region number.
The disc loaded has an incompatible region
number for the recorder and so will not play.
• Cannot record any more titles.
• No more space for file management
data.
The disc control data limit has been reached, or
the maximum number of chapters and/or titles
has been reached. Erase titles/chapters or
combine chapters.
• This disc cannot be recorded. Undo
the finalization.
The disc was finalized on a non-Pioneer DVD
recorder. Undo the finalization in order to
recording/editing.
• Cannot play this disc.
• This disc cannot be recorded.
• Cannot read the CPRM information.
• Could not record the information to
the disc.
The disc may be dirty or damaged. Take out the
disc, clean it and retry. If the error persists, use a
new disc. If the error appears even with a new disc,
please ask your nearest Pioneer-authorized service
center or your dealer to carry out repairs.
• Cannot edit.
• Could not initialize disc.
• Could not complete finalization
successfully.
• Could not undo finalization
successfully.
• Could not successfully unlock the
disc.
• Incompatible or unreadable disc.
The disc loaded is a playback-only disc type. This
display may also appear if the disc is dirty or
damaged.
• Cannot record to a disc that is not
CPRM compatible.
The video source is copy-once protected. Use a VR
mode DVD-R/-RW disc with CPRM for recording.
• Cannot record this content using
Video mode recording.
• This video cannot be recorded to
DVD+R/+RW.
• This content is copy protected.
The video source is copy-protected and cannot be
recorded.
• Incorrect CPRM information.
The recorder could not read the CPRM
information. The recorder may be damaged —
please ask your nearest Pioneer-authorized service
center or your dealer to carry out repairs.
151
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Message
Explanation/Action
• Repairing disc.
• Repairing the HDD.
During recording, the power was cut. This display
appears when the power is restored.
• Could not repair the disc.
The recorder was unable to repair the disc after a
power cut. The contents of the recording will be lost.
• Overheating has stopped operation.
Press DISPLAY to clear message.
The internal temperature of the recorder has
exceeded the operating limit. If this message
reappears, please ask your nearest Pioneer-
authorized service center or your dealer to carry
out repairs.
• HDD optimization is recommended.
This can be done using Disc Setup.
The HDD should be optimized (basically, HDD
housekeeping) to maintain playback and recording
performance.
• Please perform HDD optimization.
This can be done using Disc Setup.
The HDD is in more urgent need of optimization in
order to maintain performance.
• The HDD has not been sufficiently
optimized. Please optimize again.
If this message appears repeatedly after
optimizing the HDD it is likely that there is not
enough free space on the HDD for optimization to
complete properly. Please erase some titles from
the HDD and optimize again.
• An error occurred. Please consult the This message is displayed when information from
service center. Note that contents on the HDD cannot be read. The HDD may be
the HDD may be erased when servicing damaged or broken. Please ask your nearest
Pioneer-authorized service center or your dealer to
carry out repairs.
this unit.
As the HDD info cannot be properly read, no new
recordings can be made. Reinitializing the HDD
(page 123) may result in your being able to make
recording again. Note that reinitializing the HDD
will erase all recorded contents, including
protected files.
• The Hard Disk Drive info is incorrect.
Use the Disc Setup menu to reinitialize.
• This signal’s TV system is different
from the recorder’s setting.
The TV system (PAL, NTSC, etc.) of the current
channel is different from the TV system settings of
this recorder.
• Recording failed due to a TV system
mismatch. Press DISPLAY to clear
message.
The timer recording failed because the TV system
of the channel set for recording was different from
the setting of the recorder.
• Playback has stopped because the TV During recording or timer recording standby, the
system is different than the recording. TV System (PAL, NTSC, etc.) of the playback video
changed, causing playback to stop automatically.
152
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Message
Explanation/Action
• You are not allowed to watch this
Conditional Access Programme.
A CA module or smart card (obtained from your
service provider) is required to watch the selected
programme. Insert the supplied module or card
into the Common Interface card slot on the front
panel of the recorder (page 25).
• There is no DV input or the input
signal is unrecordable.
No signal was detected at the DV IN jack. This may
appear if a blank section of DV tape is playing in
the connected camcorder.
• No DV camcorder connected.
The camcorder is not connected properly, or the
camcorder is switched off.
• You cannot connect more than one
DV camcorder at a time.
This recorder’s DV jack supports connection to
just one camcorder.
• Cannot operate the DV camcorder.
This recorder cannot operate the DV camcorder.
Try switching off the camcorder then turn it back
on again.
• Could not operate the DV camcorder. This recorder was not able to operate the DV
camcorder.
• The DV camcorder is not set for
The camcorder is in camera mode. Switch it to
playback. Please select playback mode playback mode.
on the DV camcorder.
• The printer is not ready or is not
connected. Please check the printer.
This message is displayed when communication
could not be established with the printer. See the
Troubleshooting section if you do not know the
cause.
• Printing has been cancelled
because ...
This message is displayed when there is a printer
error during printing. After checking the printer for
the cause of the error, either reconnect the printer
and start the printing job again, or select “Yes” to
resume printing (select “No” to cancel the print
job). See also the operating instructions that came
with your printer for possible causes of print
errors.
153
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Front-panel displays
17
The table below shows a list of error messages that you may encounter when using the
recorder and an explanation of their meaning.
Message
• E01
Explanation/Action
The HDD may be damaged or broken. Please ask
your nearest Pioneer-authorized service center or
your dealer to carry out repairs.
• E02
As the HDD info cannot be properly read, no new
recordings can be made. Reinitializing the HDD
(page 123) may result in your being able to make
recording again. Note that reinitializing the HDD will
erase all recorded contents, including protected files.
Language code list
Language (Language code letter), Language code
Japanese (ja), 1001
English (en), 0514
French (fr), 0618
German (de), 0405
Italian (it), 0920
Spanish (es), 0519
Chinese (zh), 2608
Dutch (nl), 1412
Portuguese (pt), 1620
Swedish (sv), 1922
Russian (ru), 1821
Greek (el), 0512
Bhutani (dz), 0426
Esperanto (eo), 0515
Estonian (et), 0520
Basque (eu), 0521
Persian (fa), 0601
Finnish (fi), 0609
Fiji (fj), 0610
Faroese (fo), 0615
Frisian (fy), 0625
Kirghiz (ky), 1125
Latin (la), 1201
Lingala (ln), 1214
Laotian (lo), 1215
Lithuanian (lt), 1220
Latvian (lv), 1222
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908
Sinhalese (si), 1909
Slovak (sk), 1911
Slovenian (sl), 1912
Samoan (sm), 1913
Shona (sn), 1914
Somali (so), 1915
Albanian (sq), 1917
Serbian (sr), 1918
Siswati (ss), 1919
Sesotho (st), 1920
Sundanese (su), 1921
Swahili (sw), 1923
Tamil (ta), 2001
Telugu (te), 2005
Tajik (tg), 2007
Thai (th), 2008
Tigrinya (ti), 2009
Turkmen (tk), 2011
Tagalog (tl), 2012
Setswana (tn), 2014
Tonga (to), 2015
Malagasy (mg), 1307
Maori (mi), 1309
Macedonian (mk), 1311
Malayalam (ml), 1312
Mongolian (mn), 1314
Moldavian (mo), 1315
Marathi (mr), 1318
Malay (ms), 1319
Maltese (mt), 1320
Burmese (my), 1325
Nauru (na), 1401
Nepali (ne), 1405
Occitan (oc), 1503
Oromo (om), 1513
Oriya (or), 1518
Irish (ga), 0701
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704
Galician (gl), 0712
Guarani (gn), 0714
Gujarati (gu), 0721
Hausa (ha), 0801
Hindi (hi), 0809
Croatian (hr), 0818
Hungarian (hu), 0821
Armenian (hy), 0825
Interlingua (ia), 0901
Interlingue (ie), 0905
Inupiak (ik), 0911
Indonesian (in), 0914
Icelandic (is), 0919
Hebrew (iw), 0923
Yiddish (ji), 1009
Javanese (jw), 1023
Georgian (ka), 1101
Kazakh (kk), 1111
Greenlandic (kl), 1112
Cambodian (km), 1113
Kannada (kn), 1114
Korean (ko), 1115
Kashmiri (ks), 1119
Kurdish (ku), 1121
Polish (pl), 1612
Czech (cs), 0319
Norwegian (no), 1415
Afar (aa), 0101
Abkhazian (ab), 0102
Afrikaans (af), 0106
Amharic (am), 0113
Arabic (ar), 0118
Assamese (as), 0119
Aymara (ay), 0125
Azerbaijani (az), 0126
Bashkir (ba), 0201
Byelorussian (be), 0205
Bulgarian (bg), 0207
Bihari (bh), 0208
Bislama (bi), 0209
Bengali (bn), 0214
Tibetan (bo), 0215
Breton (br), 0218
Catalan (ca), 0301
Corsican (co), 0315
Welsh (cy), 0325
Panjabi (pa), 1601
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Turkish (tr), 2018
Quechua (qu), 1721
Rhaeto-Romance (rm),
1813
Kirundi (rn), 1814
Romanian (ro), 1815
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823
Sanskrit (sa), 1901
Sindhi (sd), 1904
Sangho (sg), 1907
Tsonga (ts), 2019
Tatar (tt), 2020
Twi (tw), 2023
Ukrainian (uk), 2111
Urdu (ur), 2118
Uzbek (uz), 2126
Vietnamese (vi), 2209
Volapük (vo), 2215
Wolof (wo), 2315
Xhosa (xh), 2408
Yoruba (yo), 2515
Zulu (zu), 2621
Danish (da), 0401
154
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
Country/Area code list
Country/Area, Country/Area code, Code letter
Argentina, 0118, ar
Australia, 0121, au
Austria, 0120, at
Belgium, 0205, be
Brazil, 0218, br
Canada, 0301, ca
Chile, 0312, cl
Finland, 0609, fi
France, 0618, fr
Germany, 0405, de
Hong Kong, 0811, hk
India, 0914, in
Indonesia, 0904, id
Italy, 0920, it
Japan, 1016, jp
Malaysia, 1325, my
Mexico, 1324, mx
Netherlands, 1412, nl
New Zealand, 1426, nz
Norway, 1415, no
Pakistan, 1611, pk
Philippines, 1608, ph
Portugal, 1620, pt
Singapore, 1907, sg
Spain, 0519, es
Sweden, 1905, se
Switzerland, 0308, ch
Taiwan, 2023, tw
Thailand, 2008, th
United Kingdom, 0702, gb
USA, 2119, us
China, 0314, cn
Denmark, 0411, dk
Korea, Republic of, 1118, kr
Russian Federation, 1821, ru
Screen sizes and disc formats
When viewing on a standard TV or monitor
Screen format of disc Setting
Appearance
16:9
4:3 (Letter Box)
4:3 (Pan & Scan)
The programme is shown in widescreen with
black bars at the top and bottom of the
screen.
The sides of the programme are cropped so
that the picture fills the whole screen.
4:3
4:3 (Letter Box)
4:3 (Pan & Scan)
The programme is presented correctly on
either setting.
When viewing on a widescreen TV or monitor
Screen format of disc Setting
Appearance
16:9
16:9
The programme is presented in widescreen.
4:3
16:9
Your TV will determine how the picture is
presented — check the manual that came
with the TV for details.
155
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Handling discs
17
For more detailed care information see the
instructions that come with discs.
When holding discs of any type, take care
not to leave fingerprints, dirt or scratches on
the disc surface. Hold the disc by its edge or
by the center hole and edge.
Do not load more than one disc into the
recorder.
Damaged discs
Damaged or dirty discs can affect playback
and recording performance. Take care also
not to scratch the label side of the disc.
Although not as fragile as the recorded side,
scratches can still result in a disc becoming
unusable.
Discs spin at high speed inside the recorder.
If you can see that a disc is cracked,
chipped, warped, or otherwise damaged,
don’t risk using it; you could end up
damaging the recorder.
This recorder is designed for use with
conventional, fully circular discs only. Use of
shaped discs is not recommended for this
product. Pioneer disclaims all liability
arising in connection with the use of shaped
discs.
Should a disc become marked with
fingerprints, dust, etc., clean using a soft,
dry cloth, wiping the disc lightly from the
center to the outside edge. Do not wipe with
a circular motion.
If necessary, use a cloth soaked in alcohol,
or a commercially available CD/DVD
cleaning kit to clean a disc more thoroughly.
Never use benzine, thinner or other cleaning
agents, including products designed for
cleaning vinyl records.
Cleaning the pickup lens
The HDD/DVD recorder’s lens should not
become dirty in normal use, but if for some
reason it should malfunction due to dust or
dirt, consult your nearest Pioneer-authorized
service center. Although lens cleaners are
commercially available, we do not
Storing discs
Although CDs and DVD discs are more
durable than vinyl records, you should still
take care to handle and store discs correctly.
When you’re not using a disc, return it to its
case and store upright. Avoid leaving discs
in excessively cold, humid, or hot
environments (including under direct
sunlight).
recommend using them since some may
damage the lens.
Don’t glue paper or put stickers onto the
disc, or use a pencil, ball-point pen or other
sharp-tipped writing instrument. These
could all damage the disc.
Condensation
Condensation may form inside the recorder
if it is brought into a warm room from
outside, or if the temperature of the room
rises quickly. Although the condensation
won’t damage the recorder, it may
temporarily impair its performance. For this
reason you should leave it to adjust to the
warmer temperature for about an hour
before switching on and using.
156
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Hints on installation
17
Moving the recorder
We want you to enjoy using this unit for
years to come, so please bear in mind the
following points when choosing a suitable
location for it:
If you need to move the recorder, first
remove the disc, if loaded, and close the disc
tray. Next, press ꢂ STANDBY/ON to switch
the power to standby, checking that the
POWER OFF indication in the display goes
off. Wait at least two minutes. Lastly,
disconnect the power cord. Never lift or
move the unit during playback or recording
— discs rotate at a high speed and may be
damaged.
Do...
ꢆ
Use in a well-ventilated room.
ꢆ
Place on a solid, flat, level surface, such
as a table, shelf or stereo rack.
Don’t...
ꢇ
Use in a place exposed to high
Resetting the recorder
temperatures or humidity, including near
radiators and other heat-generating
appliances.
If you need to, you can reset the recorder to
all its factory settings.
ꢇ
Place on a window sill or other place
1
Make sure that the recorder is on.
where the recorder will be exposed to direct
sunlight.
2
Using the front panel controls, press
and hold ꢄ (Stop) and press ꢂ STANDBY/
ON.
The recorder turns off with all settings reset.
ꢇ
Use in a dusty or damp environment or
in a room where it will be exposed to
excessive cigarette smoke.
ꢇ
Place directly on top of an amplifier, or
other component in your stereo system that
becomes hot in use.
ꢇ
Use near a television or monitor as you
may experience interference — especially if
the television uses an indoor antenna.
ꢇ
Use in a kitchen or other room where the
recorder may be exposed to smoke or steam.
Use on a thick rug or carpet, or cover
ꢇ
with cloth — this may prevent proper cooling
of the unit.
ꢇ
Place on an unstable surface, or one that
is not large enough to support all four of the
unit’s feet.
157
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
Specifications
17
DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL
Fine (XP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h 51 m
Standard Play (SP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 3 h 35 m
Long Play (LP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 7 h 11 m
Extended Play (EP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 10 h 46 m
Super Long Play (SLP). . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 14 h 21 m
Super Extended Play (SEP). . . . . . . Approx. 17 h 57 m
(DVD-R DL only)
Manual Mode (MN)
DVD-R DL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h 51 m to 24 h
DVD+R DL . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h 51 m to 14 h 21 m
General
Power requirements . . . . . 220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz
Power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 W
Power consumption in standby mode . . . . . . . 0.69 W
(Front panel display: off)
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8 kg
Dimensions
. . . . . . . . . . . .420 mm (W) x 77 mm (H) x 288 mm (D)
Operating temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . +5 °C to +35 °C
Operating humidity
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 % to 85 % (no condensation)
TV system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .NTSC (external input only)
/PAL/SECAM
Timer
Programmes . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 month/32 programmes
Clock . . . . . . . . . . Quartz lock (24-hour digital display)
Tuner (analog)
Readable discs
Receivable channels
DVD-Video, DVD-RW, DVD-R, DVD+R, DVD+RW,
DVD-RAM, Video CD, Super VCD, CD, CD-R/-RW
(WMA, MP3, JPEG, CD-DA, DivX)
SECAM B/G
PAL I
Frequency
PAL B/G
Frequency
Channel
Channel
VHF (low)
VHF (high)
47 MHz to 89 MHz
E2 to E4
X to Z
44 MHz to 89 MHz
A to C
X to Z
Recording discs and formats
DVD-R/-RW: VR mode and Video mode
DVD+R/+RW: +VR mode
104 MHz to 300 MHz E5 to E12
S1 to S20
104 MHz to 300 MHz
D to J
11, 13
S1 to S20
M1 to M10
U1 to U10
DVD-RAM: VR mode
DVD-R DL: VR mode and Video mode
DVD+R DL: +VR mode
Hyper
UHF
302 MHz to 470 MHz S21 to S41 302 MHz to 470 MHz S21 to S41
470 MHz to 862 MHz E21 to E69 470 MHz to 862 MHz E21 to E69
SECAM D/K
SECAM L
PAL D/K
Channel
Frequency
Frequency
49 MHz to 94 MHz
Channel
FB, FC1, FC
VHF (low)
VHF (high)
49 MHz to 65 MHz
R1 to R5
Video recording format
Sampling frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.5 MHz
Compression format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .MPEG
F1 to F6
B to Q
104 MHz to 300 MHz
104 MHz to 300 MHz R6 to R12
S1 to S20
STEREO
B/G - A2
I - NICAM
L - NICAM
B/G - NICAM
D/K - NICAM
Hyper
UHF
300 MHz to 470 MHz
470 MHz to 862 MHz
302 MHz to 470 MHz S21 to S41
470 MHz to 862 MHz E21 to E69
S21 to S41
21 to 69
Audio recording format
Sampling frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 kHz
Compression format . . . . Dolby Digital or Linear PCM
(uncompressed)
Tuner (digital)
Receiving system. . . . . . . . . . DVB-T (2 K/8 K COFDM)
Tuner VHF/UHF
Recording time
HDD (250 GB)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VHF band III (174 MHz to 230 MHz)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . UHF band IV, V (470 MHz to 862 MHz)
Auto Channel Preset . . . . . . . . . . 999 ch, Auto Preset,
Auto Label, Auto Sort
Audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stereo MPEG layer I/II
Audio Decoder
XP+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 36 h
Fine (XP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 53 h
Standard Play (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 106 h
Long Play (LP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 212 h
Extended Play (EP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 319 h
Super Long Play (SLP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 425 h
Super Extended Play (SEP) . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 532 h
Manual Mode (MN). . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 36 h to 711 h
. . . . . Sampling frequencies: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz
This product’s digital tuner has been confirmed for use
in the following countries: Belgium, France, Germany,
Italy, Spain, Denmark, Finland, Netherlands, Sweden,
Switzerland, UK.
DVD-R/-RW, DVD+R/+RW, DVD-RAM
Fine (XP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h
Standard Play (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 2 h
Long Play (LP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 4 h
Extended Play (EP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 6 h
Super Long Play (SLP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 8 h
Super Extended Play (SEP) . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 10 h
(DVD-R/-RW, DVD-RAM only)
Manual Mode (MN)
DVD-R/-RW/-RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h to 13 h
DVD+R/+RW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h to 8 h
158
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
17
AV Connectors (21-pin connector assignment)
AV connector input/output . . . . . . . . 21-pin connector
This connector provides the video and audio signals
for connection to a compatible colour TV or monitor.
Input/Output
Antenna
. . . . 75
Ω
Ω
IEC 169-2 connector for VHF/UHF in/out (analog)
IEC 169-2 connector for VHF/UHF in/out (digital)
. . . . 75
Video input. . . . . . . . . . . .AV2 (Input 1), Input 2 (front),
Input 3 (rear)
Input level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (Input 1),
RCA jack (Input 2, Input 3)
Video output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1, Output
Output level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (AV1),
RCA jack (Output)
S-Video input . . . . . . . . . .AV2 (Input 1), Input 2 (front),
Input 3 (rear)
Y (luminance) - Input level. . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 Ω)
C (colour) - Input level . . . . . . . . . . 300 mVp-p (75 Ω)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (Input 1),
4 pin mini DIN (Input 2, Input 3)
S-Video output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1, Output
Y (luminance) - Output level . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 Ω)
C (colour) - Output level. . . . . . . . . 300 mVp-p (75 Ω)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (AV1),
4 pin mini DIN (Output)
PIN no.
AV1 (RGB)-TV / AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER)
1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Audio 2/R out / Audio 2/R out
2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . – / Audio 2/R in
11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G out / G in
3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio 1/L out / Audio 1/L out
6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . – / Audio 1/L in
15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R or C out / R or C in
4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .GND
17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .GND
7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B out / B in
19. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Video out or Y out / Video out
20. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . – / Video in or Y in
8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Status
21. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .GND
Component video output
Output level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Y: 1.0 Vp-p (75 Ω)
PB, PR: 0.7 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Supplied accessories
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Dry cell batteries (AA/R6P). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Audio/Video cable (red/white/yellow) . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
G-LINK™ cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
RF antenna cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Operating Instructions
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RCA jacks
RGB input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV2 (Input 1)
Input level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (Input 1)
RGB output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1
Output level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 Vp-p (75 Ω)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (AV1)
Audio input . . . . . . . . . . .AV2 (Input 1), Input 2 (front),
Input 3 (rear) L/R
Warranty card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Note: The specifications and design of this product are
subject to change without notice, due to improvement.
During audio input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 V rms
(Input impedance: more than 22 kΩ)
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (Input 1),
RCA jacks (Input 2)
Audio output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1, Output
During audio output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 V rms
(Output impedance: less than 1.5 kΩ)
®
This product includes FontAvenue fonts licenced
by NEC Corporation. FontAvenue is a registered
trademark of NEC Corporation.
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (AV1),
RCA jacks (Output)
Microsoft product screen shots reprinted with
permission from Microsoft Corporation.
Control input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini jack
Digital audio output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Coaxial
G-LINK™. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini jack
Common Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CA module
DV input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 pin (front)
(i.LINK/IEEE 1394 standard)
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Type A (front), Type B (front)
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 pin
159
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
http://www.pioneer.co.uk
http://www.pioneer.eu
Published by Pioneer Corporation.
Copyright © 2007 Pioneer Corporation.
All rights reserved.
PIONEER CORPORATION
4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.
P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90801-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.
300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R 0P2, Canada TEL: 1-877-283-5901, 905-479-4411
PIONEER EUROPE NV
Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11
PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD.
253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 65-6472-7555
PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.
178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300
PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V.
Blvd.Manuel Avila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Mexico,D.F. 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270
K002_B_En
Printed in UK
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
<VRB1459-A>
|